Also copy EI_OSABI field
[binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include "bfd.h"
39 #include "bfdlink.h"
40 #include "libbfd.h"
41 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-psinfo.h"
46
47 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 #include CORE_HEADER
49 #endif
50
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct bfd_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
56 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 file_ptr offset);
58
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64
65 void
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 {
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 }
78
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80
81 void
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 {
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 }
94
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96
97 void
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 {
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 }
105
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107
108 void
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 {
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 }
116
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118
119 void
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 {
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 }
130
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132
133 void
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 {
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 }
144
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146
147 void
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 {
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 }
158
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160
161 void
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 {
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 }
172
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174
175 void
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 {
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 }
182
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184
185 void
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 {
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 }
192
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195
196 unsigned long
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 {
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 unsigned long h = 0;
201 unsigned long g;
202 int ch;
203
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 {
206 h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 {
209 h ^= g >> 24;
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 h ^= g;
213 }
214 }
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
216 }
217
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220
221 unsigned long
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 {
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
226 unsigned char ch;
227
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
231 }
232
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bfd_boolean
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 size_t object_size,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 {
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 return FALSE;
244
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 {
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 if (o == NULL)
250 return FALSE;
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 }
254 return TRUE;
255 }
256
257
258 bfd_boolean
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 {
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 bed->target_id);
264 }
265
266 bfd_boolean
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 return FALSE;
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 }
275
276 static char *
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 {
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 file_ptr offset;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 if (i_shdrp == 0
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 return NULL;
289
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 {
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL
301 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
302 shstrtab = NULL;
303 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
304 {
305 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
306 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
307 shstrtab = NULL;
308 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
309 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
310 the string table over and over. */
311 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
312 }
313 else
314 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
315 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
316 }
317 return (char *) shstrtab;
318 }
319
320 char *
321 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
322 unsigned int shindex,
323 unsigned int strindex)
324 {
325 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
326
327 if (strindex == 0)
328 return "";
329
330 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
331 return NULL;
332
333 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
334
335 if (hdr->contents == NULL
336 && bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
337 return NULL;
338
339 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
340 {
341 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
342 (*_bfd_error_handler)
343 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
344 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
345 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
346 ? ".shstrtab"
347 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
348 return NULL;
349 }
350
351 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
352 }
353
354 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
355 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
356 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
357 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
358 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
359 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
360 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
361
362 Elf_Internal_Sym *
363 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
364 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
365 size_t symcount,
366 size_t symoffset,
367 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
368 void *extsym_buf,
369 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
370 {
371 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
372 void *alloc_ext;
373 const bfd_byte *esym;
374 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
375 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
376 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
377 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
378 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
379 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
380 size_t extsym_size;
381 bfd_size_type amt;
382 file_ptr pos;
383
384 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
385 abort ();
386
387 if (symcount == 0)
388 return intsym_buf;
389
390 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
391 shndx_hdr = NULL;
392 if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
393 shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
394
395 /* Read the symbols. */
396 alloc_ext = NULL;
397 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
398 alloc_intsym = NULL;
399 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
400 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
401 amt = symcount * extsym_size;
402 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
403 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
404 {
405 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
406 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
407 }
408 if (extsym_buf == NULL
409 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
410 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
411 {
412 intsym_buf = NULL;
413 goto out;
414 }
415
416 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
417 extshndx_buf = NULL;
418 else
419 {
420 amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
421 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
422 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
423 {
424 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
425 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
426 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
427 }
428 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
429 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
430 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
431 {
432 intsym_buf = NULL;
433 goto out;
434 }
435 }
436
437 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
438 {
439 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
440 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
441 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
442 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
443 goto out;
444 }
445
446 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
447 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
448 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
449 shndx = extshndx_buf;
450 isym < isymend;
451 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
452 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
453 {
454 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
455 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
456 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
457 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
458 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
459 free (alloc_intsym);
460 intsym_buf = NULL;
461 goto out;
462 }
463
464 out:
465 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
466 free (alloc_ext);
467 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
468 free (alloc_extshndx);
469
470 return intsym_buf;
471 }
472
473 /* Look up a symbol name. */
474 const char *
475 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
476 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
477 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
478 asection *sym_sec)
479 {
480 const char *name;
481 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
482 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
483
484 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
485 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
486 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
487 {
488 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
489 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
490 }
491
492 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
493 if (name == NULL)
494 name = "(null)";
495 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
496 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
497
498 return name;
499 }
500
501 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
502 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
503 pointers. */
504
505 typedef union elf_internal_group {
506 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
507 unsigned int flags;
508 } Elf_Internal_Group;
509
510 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
511 signature just a string? */
512
513 static const char *
514 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
515 {
516 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
517 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
518 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
519 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
520
521 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
522 that it is a symbol table section. */
523 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
524 return NULL;
525 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
526 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
527 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
528 return NULL;
529
530 /* Go read the symbol. */
531 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
532 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
533 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
534 return NULL;
535
536 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
537 }
538
539 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
540
541 static bfd_boolean
542 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
543 {
544 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
545
546 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
547 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
548 if (num_group == 0)
549 {
550 unsigned int i, shnum;
551
552 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
553 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
554 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
555 num_group = 0;
556
557 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
558 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
559 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
560 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
561 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
562
563 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
564 {
565 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
566
567 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
568 num_group += 1;
569 }
570
571 if (num_group == 0)
572 {
573 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
574 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
575 }
576 else
577 {
578 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
579 so we can find them quickly. */
580 bfd_size_type amt;
581
582 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
583 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
584 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
585 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
586 return FALSE;
587
588 num_group = 0;
589 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
590 {
591 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
592
593 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
594 {
595 unsigned char *src;
596 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
597
598 /* Add to list of sections. */
599 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
600 num_group += 1;
601
602 /* Read the raw contents. */
603 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
604 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
605 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
606 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
607 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
608 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
609 {
610 _bfd_error_handler
611 (_("%B: Corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
612 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
613 return FALSE;
614 }
615
616 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
617
618 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
619 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
620 != shdr->sh_size))
621 return FALSE;
622
623 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
624 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
625 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
626 pointers. */
627 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
628 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
629 while (1)
630 {
631 unsigned int idx;
632
633 src -= 4;
634 --dest;
635 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
636 if (src == shdr->contents)
637 {
638 dest->flags = idx;
639 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
640 shdr->bfd_section->flags
641 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
642 break;
643 }
644 if (idx >= shnum)
645 {
646 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
647 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
648 idx = 0;
649 }
650 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
651 }
652 }
653 }
654 }
655 }
656
657 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
658 {
659 unsigned int i;
660
661 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
662 {
663 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
664 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
665 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
666
667 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
668 section is a member. */
669 while (--n_elt != 0)
670 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
671 {
672 asection *s = NULL;
673
674 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
675 other members to see if any others are linked via
676 next_in_group. */
677 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
678 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
679 while (--n_elt != 0)
680 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
681 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
682 break;
683 if (n_elt != 0)
684 {
685 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
686 insert current section in circular list. */
687 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
688 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
689 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
690 }
691 else
692 {
693 const char *gname;
694
695 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
696 if (gname == NULL)
697 return FALSE;
698 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
699
700 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
701 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
702 }
703
704 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
705 new member. */
706 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
707 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
708
709 i = num_group - 1;
710 break;
711 }
712 }
713 }
714
715 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
716 {
717 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
718 abfd, newsect);
719 }
720 return TRUE;
721 }
722
723 bfd_boolean
724 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
725 {
726 unsigned int i;
727 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
728 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
729 asection *s;
730
731 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
732 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
733 {
734 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
735 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
736 {
737 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
738 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
739 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
740 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
741 if (elfsec == 0)
742 {
743 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
744 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
745 bed->link_order_error_handler
746 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
747 abfd, s);
748 }
749 else
750 {
751 asection *linksec = NULL;
752
753 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
754 {
755 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
756 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
757 }
758
759 /* PR 1991, 2008:
760 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
761 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
762 if (linksec == NULL)
763 {
764 (*_bfd_error_handler)
765 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
766 s->owner, s, elfsec);
767 result = FALSE;
768 }
769
770 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
771 }
772 }
773 }
774
775 /* Process section groups. */
776 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
777 return result;
778
779 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
780 {
781 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
782 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
783 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
784
785 while (--n_elt != 0)
786 if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
787 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
788 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
789 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
790 /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
791 output object files. We adjust the group section size here
792 so that relocatable link will work correctly when
793 relocation sections are in section group in input object
794 files. */
795 shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
796 else
797 {
798 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
799 (*_bfd_error_handler)
800 (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
801 abfd,
802 (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
803 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
804 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
805 ->e_shstrndx),
806 idx->shdr->sh_name),
807 shdr->bfd_section->name);
808 result = FALSE;
809 }
810 }
811 return result;
812 }
813
814 bfd_boolean
815 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
816 {
817 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
818 }
819
820 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
821 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
822
823 bfd_boolean
824 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
825 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
826 const char *name,
827 int shindex)
828 {
829 asection *newsect;
830 flagword flags;
831 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
832
833 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
834 return TRUE;
835
836 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
837 if (newsect == NULL)
838 return FALSE;
839
840 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
841 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
842 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
843
844 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
845 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
846 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
847
848 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
849
850 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
851 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
852 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
853 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
854 return FALSE;
855
856 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
857 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
858 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
859 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
860 flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
861 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
862 {
863 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
864 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
865 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
866 }
867 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
868 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
869 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
870 flags |= SEC_CODE;
871 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
872 flags |= SEC_DATA;
873 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
874 {
875 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
876 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
877 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
878 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
879 }
880 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
881 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
882 return FALSE;
883 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
884 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
885 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
886 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
887
888 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
889 {
890 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
891 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
892 if (name [0] == '.')
893 {
894 const char *p;
895 int n;
896 if (name[1] == 'd')
897 p = ".debug", n = 6;
898 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
899 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
900 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
901 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
902 else if (name[1] == 'l')
903 p = ".line", n = 5;
904 else if (name[1] == 's')
905 p = ".stab", n = 5;
906 else if (name[1] == 'z')
907 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
908 else
909 p = NULL, n = 0;
910 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
911 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
912 }
913 }
914
915 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
916 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
917 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
918 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
919 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
920 all but one of the sections. */
921 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
922 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
923 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
924
925 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
926 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
927 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
928 return FALSE;
929
930 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
931 return FALSE;
932
933 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
934 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
935 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
936 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
937 {
938 bfd_byte *contents;
939
940 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
941 return FALSE;
942
943 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
944 free (contents);
945 }
946
947 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
948 {
949 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
950 unsigned int i, nload;
951
952 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
953 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
954 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
955 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
956 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
957 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
958 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
959 break;
960 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
961 ++nload;
962 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
963 return TRUE;
964
965 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
966 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
967 {
968 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
969 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
970 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
971 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
972 {
973 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
974 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
975 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
976 else
977 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
978 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
979 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
980 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
981 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
982 segment will contain sections with contiguous
983 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
984 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
985 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
986
987 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
988 offsets whether a section with zero size should
989 be placed at the end of one segment or the
990 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
991 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
992 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
993 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
994 break;
995 }
996 }
997 }
998
999 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1000 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1001 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1002 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1003 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1004 {
1005 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1006 char *new_name;
1007
1008 if (bfd_is_section_compressed (abfd, newsect))
1009 {
1010 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1011 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1012 action = decompress;
1013 }
1014 else
1015 {
1016 /* Normal section. Check if we should compress. */
1017 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS) && newsect->size != 0)
1018 action = compress;
1019 }
1020
1021 new_name = NULL;
1022 switch (action)
1023 {
1024 case nothing:
1025 break;
1026 case compress:
1027 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1028 {
1029 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1030 (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1031 abfd, name);
1032 return FALSE;
1033 }
1034 if (name[1] != 'z')
1035 {
1036 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1037
1038 new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
1039 if (new_name == NULL)
1040 return FALSE;
1041 new_name[0] = '.';
1042 new_name[1] = 'z';
1043 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
1044 }
1045 break;
1046 case decompress:
1047 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1048 {
1049 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1050 (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1051 abfd, name);
1052 return FALSE;
1053 }
1054 if (name[1] == 'z')
1055 {
1056 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
1057
1058 new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
1059 if (new_name == NULL)
1060 return FALSE;
1061 new_name[0] = '.';
1062 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
1063 }
1064 break;
1065 }
1066 if (new_name != NULL)
1067 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1068 }
1069
1070 return TRUE;
1071 }
1072
1073 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1074 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1075 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1076 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1077 };
1078
1079 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1080 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1081 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1082 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1083 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1084 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1085 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1086 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1087 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1088
1089 bfd_reloc_status_type
1090 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1091 arelent *reloc_entry,
1092 asymbol *symbol,
1093 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1094 asection *input_section,
1095 bfd *output_bfd,
1096 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1097 {
1098 if (output_bfd != NULL
1099 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1100 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1101 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1102 {
1103 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1104 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1105 }
1106
1107 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1108 }
1109 \f
1110 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1111 another. */
1112
1113 bfd_boolean
1114 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1115 {
1116 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1117 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1118 return TRUE;
1119
1120 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1121 {
1122 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1123 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1124 }
1125
1126 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1127
1128 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1129 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1130 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1131
1132 /* Copy object attributes. */
1133 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 static const char *
1138 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1139 {
1140 const char *pt;
1141 switch (p_type)
1142 {
1143 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1144 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1145 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1146 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1147 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1148 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1149 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1150 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1151 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1152 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1153 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1154 default: pt = NULL; break;
1155 }
1156 return pt;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* Print out the program headers. */
1160
1161 bfd_boolean
1162 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1163 {
1164 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1165 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1166 asection *s;
1167 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1168
1169 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1170 if (p != NULL)
1171 {
1172 unsigned int i, c;
1173
1174 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1175 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1176 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1177 {
1178 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1179 char buf[20];
1180
1181 if (pt == NULL)
1182 {
1183 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1184 pt = buf;
1185 }
1186 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1187 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1188 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1189 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1190 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1191 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1192 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1193 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1194 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1195 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1196 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1197 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1198 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1199 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1200 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1201 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1202 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1203 fprintf (f, "\n");
1204 }
1205 }
1206
1207 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1208 if (s != NULL)
1209 {
1210 unsigned int elfsec;
1211 unsigned long shlink;
1212 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1213 size_t extdynsize;
1214 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1215
1216 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1217
1218 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1219 goto error_return;
1220
1221 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1222 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1223 goto error_return;
1224 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1225
1226 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1227 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1228
1229 extdyn = dynbuf;
1230 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1231 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1232 {
1233 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1234 const char *name = "";
1235 char ab[20];
1236 bfd_boolean stringp;
1237 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1238
1239 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1240
1241 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1242 break;
1243
1244 stringp = FALSE;
1245 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1246 {
1247 default:
1248 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1249 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1250
1251 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1252 {
1253 sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1254 name = ab;
1255 }
1256 break;
1257
1258 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1259 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1260 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1261 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1262 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1263 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1264 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1265 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1266 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1267 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1268 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1269 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1270 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1271 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1272 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1273 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1274 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1275 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1276 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1277 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1278 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1279 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1280 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1281 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1282 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1283 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1284 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1285 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1286 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1287 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1288 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1289 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1290 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1291 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1292 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1293 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1294 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1295 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1296 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1297 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1298 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1299 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1300 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1301 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1302 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1303 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1304 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1305 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1306 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1307 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1308 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1309 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1310 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1311 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1312 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1313 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1314 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1315 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1316 }
1317
1318 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1319 if (! stringp)
1320 {
1321 fprintf (f, "0x");
1322 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1323 }
1324 else
1325 {
1326 const char *string;
1327 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1328
1329 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1330 if (string == NULL)
1331 goto error_return;
1332 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1333 }
1334 fprintf (f, "\n");
1335 }
1336
1337 free (dynbuf);
1338 dynbuf = NULL;
1339 }
1340
1341 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1342 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1343 {
1344 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1345 return FALSE;
1346 }
1347
1348 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1349 {
1350 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1351
1352 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1353 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1354 {
1355 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1356 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1357 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1358 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1359 {
1360 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1361
1362 fprintf (f, "\t");
1363 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1364 a != NULL;
1365 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1366 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1367 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1368 fprintf (f, "\n");
1369 }
1370 }
1371 }
1372
1373 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1374 {
1375 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1376
1377 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1378 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1379 {
1380 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1381
1382 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1383 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1384 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1385 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1386 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1387 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1388 }
1389 }
1390
1391 return TRUE;
1392
1393 error_return:
1394 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1395 free (dynbuf);
1396 return FALSE;
1397 }
1398
1399 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1400
1401 void
1402 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1403 void *filep,
1404 asymbol *symbol,
1405 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1406 {
1407 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1408 switch (how)
1409 {
1410 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1411 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1412 break;
1413 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1414 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1415 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1416 fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1417 break;
1418 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1419 {
1420 const char *section_name;
1421 const char *name = NULL;
1422 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1423 unsigned char st_other;
1424 bfd_vma val;
1425
1426 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1427
1428 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1429 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1430 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1431
1432 if (name == NULL)
1433 {
1434 name = symbol->name;
1435 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1436 }
1437
1438 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1439 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1440 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1441 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1442 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1443 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1444 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1445 else
1446 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1447 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1448
1449 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1450 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1451 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0
1452 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1453 {
1454 unsigned int vernum;
1455 const char *version_string;
1456
1457 vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_VERSION;
1458
1459 if (vernum == 0)
1460 version_string = "";
1461 else if (vernum == 1)
1462 version_string = "Base";
1463 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1464 version_string =
1465 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1466 else
1467 {
1468 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1469
1470 version_string = "";
1471 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1472 t != NULL;
1473 t = t->vn_nextref)
1474 {
1475 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1476
1477 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1478 {
1479 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1480 {
1481 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1482 break;
1483 }
1484 }
1485 }
1486 }
1487
1488 if ((((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_HIDDEN) == 0)
1489 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1490 else
1491 {
1492 int i;
1493
1494 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1495 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1496 putc (' ', file);
1497 }
1498 }
1499
1500 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1501 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1502
1503 switch (st_other)
1504 {
1505 case 0: break;
1506 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1507 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1508 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1509 default:
1510 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1511 everything hex. */
1512 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1513 }
1514
1515 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1516 }
1517 break;
1518 }
1519 }
1520
1521 /* Allocate an ELF string table--force the first byte to be zero. */
1522
1523 struct bfd_strtab_hash *
1524 _bfd_elf_stringtab_init (void)
1525 {
1526 struct bfd_strtab_hash *ret;
1527
1528 ret = _bfd_stringtab_init ();
1529 if (ret != NULL)
1530 {
1531 bfd_size_type loc;
1532
1533 loc = _bfd_stringtab_add (ret, "", TRUE, FALSE);
1534 BFD_ASSERT (loc == 0 || loc == (bfd_size_type) -1);
1535 if (loc == (bfd_size_type) -1)
1536 {
1537 _bfd_stringtab_free (ret);
1538 ret = NULL;
1539 }
1540 }
1541 return ret;
1542 }
1543 \f
1544 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1545
1546 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1547
1548 bfd_boolean
1549 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1550 {
1551 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1552 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1553 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1554 const char *name;
1555
1556 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1557 return FALSE;
1558
1559 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1560 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1561 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1562 hdr->sh_name);
1563 if (name == NULL)
1564 return FALSE;
1565
1566 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1567 switch (hdr->sh_type)
1568 {
1569 case SHT_NULL:
1570 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1571 return TRUE;
1572
1573 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
1574 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
1575 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
1576 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
1577 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
1578 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
1579 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
1580 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
1581 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
1582 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1583
1584 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
1585 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1586 return FALSE;
1587 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
1588 {
1589 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
1590 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
1591 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
1592 {
1593 case bfd_arch_i386:
1594 case bfd_arch_sparc:
1595 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
1596 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
1597 break;
1598 /* Otherwise fall through. */
1599 default:
1600 return FALSE;
1601 }
1602 }
1603 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1604 return FALSE;
1605 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1606 {
1607 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1608
1609 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1610 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
1611 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
1612 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1613 {
1614 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1615 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1616 }
1617 else
1618 {
1619 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1620
1621 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1622 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1623 {
1624 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1625 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1626 {
1627 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1628 break;
1629 }
1630 }
1631 }
1632 }
1633 break;
1634
1635 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table */
1636 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1637 return TRUE;
1638
1639 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1640 return FALSE;
1641 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1642 {
1643 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1644 return FALSE;
1645 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1646 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1647 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1648 hdr->sh_info = 0;
1649 return TRUE;
1650 }
1651 BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
1652 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1653 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
1654 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1655 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1656
1657 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
1658 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1659 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
1660 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1661 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1662 linker. */
1663 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1664 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1665 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1666 shindex))
1667 return FALSE;
1668
1669 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1670 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
1671 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
1672 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
1673 {
1674 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1675
1676 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1677 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1678 {
1679 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1680 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1681 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1682 break;
1683 }
1684 if (i == num_sec)
1685 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1686 {
1687 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1688 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1689 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1690 break;
1691 }
1692 if (i != shindex)
1693 return bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1694 }
1695 return TRUE;
1696
1697 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table */
1698 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1699 return TRUE;
1700
1701 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1702 return FALSE;
1703 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1704 {
1705 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1706 return FALSE;
1707 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1708 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1709 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1710 hdr->sh_info = 0;
1711 return TRUE;
1712 }
1713 BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
1714 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1715 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1716 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1717 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1718
1719 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1720 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
1721 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1722
1723 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections */
1724 if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
1725 return TRUE;
1726
1727 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
1728 elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
1729 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
1730 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
1731 return TRUE;
1732
1733 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table */
1734 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1735 return TRUE;
1736 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1737 {
1738 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1739 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1740 return TRUE;
1741 }
1742 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1743 {
1744 symtab_strtab:
1745 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1746 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1747 return TRUE;
1748 }
1749 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1750 {
1751 dynsymtab_strtab:
1752 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1753 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
1754 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
1755 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
1756 can handle it. */
1757 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1758 shindex);
1759 }
1760
1761 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
1762 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
1763 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
1764 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
1765 {
1766 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1767
1768 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1769 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1770 {
1771 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1772 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1773 {
1774 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
1775 if (i == shindex)
1776 return FALSE;
1777 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
1778 return FALSE;
1779 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
1780 goto symtab_strtab;
1781 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
1782 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
1783 }
1784 }
1785 }
1786 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1787
1788 case SHT_REL:
1789 case SHT_RELA:
1790 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
1791 {
1792 asection *target_sect;
1793 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
1794 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1795 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
1796 bfd_size_type amt;
1797
1798 if (hdr->sh_entsize
1799 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
1800 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
1801 return FALSE;
1802
1803 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
1804 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
1805 {
1806 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
1807 (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
1808 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
1809 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1810 shindex);
1811 }
1812
1813 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
1814 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
1815 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
1816 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
1817 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
1818 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
1819 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
1820
1821 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
1822 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
1823 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
1824 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
1825 {
1826 unsigned int scan;
1827 int found;
1828
1829 found = 0;
1830 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
1831 {
1832 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1833 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1834 {
1835 if (found != 0)
1836 {
1837 found = 0;
1838 break;
1839 }
1840 found = scan;
1841 }
1842 }
1843 if (found != 0)
1844 hdr->sh_link = found;
1845 }
1846
1847 /* Get the symbol table. */
1848 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1849 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1850 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
1851 return FALSE;
1852
1853 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
1854 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
1855 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
1856 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
1857 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
1858 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
1859 sh_link points to the null section. */
1860 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
1861 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
1862 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
1863 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
1864 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
1865 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1866 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1867 shindex);
1868
1869 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
1870 return FALSE;
1871 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
1872 if (target_sect == NULL)
1873 return FALSE;
1874
1875 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
1876 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1877 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
1878 else
1879 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
1880
1881 BFD_ASSERT (*p_hdr == NULL);
1882 amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
1883 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
1884 if (hdr2 == NULL)
1885 return FALSE;
1886 *hdr2 = *hdr;
1887 *p_hdr = hdr2;
1888 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
1889 target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
1890 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
1891 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
1892 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1893 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
1894 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
1895 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1896 {
1897 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
1898 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
1899 }
1900 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
1901 return TRUE;
1902 }
1903
1904 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
1905 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
1906 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
1907 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1908
1909 case SHT_GNU_versym:
1910 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
1911 return FALSE;
1912 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
1913 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
1914 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1915
1916 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
1917 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
1918 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
1919 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1920
1921 case SHT_SHLIB:
1922 return TRUE;
1923
1924 case SHT_GROUP:
1925 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
1926 return FALSE;
1927 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1928 return FALSE;
1929 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
1930 {
1931 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
1932 unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
1933 asection *s;
1934
1935 if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
1936 hdr->bfd_section->flags
1937 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1938
1939 /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
1940 idx += n_elt;
1941 while (--n_elt != 0)
1942 {
1943 --idx;
1944
1945 if (idx->shdr != NULL
1946 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
1947 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
1948 {
1949 elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
1950 break;
1951 }
1952 }
1953 }
1954 break;
1955
1956 default:
1957 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
1958 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
1959 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
1960 {
1961 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1962 return FALSE;
1963 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
1964 return TRUE;
1965 }
1966
1967 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
1968 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1969 return TRUE;
1970
1971 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
1972 {
1973 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1974 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
1975 for applications? */
1976 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1977 (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
1978 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
1979 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1980 else
1981 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
1982 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1983 shindex);
1984 }
1985 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
1986 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
1987 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
1988 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1989 (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
1990 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
1991 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
1992 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
1993 {
1994 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
1995 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
1996 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
1997 required to correctly process the section and the file should
1998 be rejected with an error message. */
1999 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2000 (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
2001 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2002 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2003 else
2004 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2005 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2006 }
2007 else
2008 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2009 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2010 (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2011 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2012
2013 return FALSE;
2014 }
2015
2016 return TRUE;
2017 }
2018
2019 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2020
2021 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2022 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2023 bfd *abfd,
2024 unsigned long r_symndx)
2025 {
2026 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2027
2028 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2029 {
2030 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2031 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2032 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2033
2034 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2035 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2036 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2037 return NULL;
2038
2039 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2040 {
2041 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2042 cache->abfd = abfd;
2043 }
2044 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2045 }
2046
2047 return &cache->sym[ent];
2048 }
2049
2050 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2051 section. */
2052
2053 asection *
2054 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2055 {
2056 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2057 return NULL;
2058 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2059 }
2060
2061 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2062 {
2063 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2064 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2065 };
2066
2067 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2068 {
2069 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2070 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2071 };
2072
2073 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2074 {
2075 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2076 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2077 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2078 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2079 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2080 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2081 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2082 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2083 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2084 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2085 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2086 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2087 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2088 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2089 };
2090
2091 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2092 {
2093 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2094 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2095 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2096 };
2097
2098 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2099 {
2100 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2101 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2102 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2103 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2104 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2105 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2106 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2107 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2108 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2109 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2110 };
2111
2112 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2113 {
2114 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2115 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2116 };
2117
2118 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2119 {
2120 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2121 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2122 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2123 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2124 };
2125
2126 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2127 {
2128 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2129 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2130 };
2131
2132 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2133 {
2134 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2135 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2136 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2137 };
2138
2139 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2140 {
2141 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2142 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2143 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2144 };
2145
2146 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2147 {
2148 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2149 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2150 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2151 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2152 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2153 };
2154
2155 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2156 {
2157 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2158 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2159 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2160 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2161 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2162 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2163 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2164 };
2165
2166 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2167 {
2168 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2169 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2170 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2171 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2172 };
2173
2174 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2175 {
2176 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2177 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2178 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2179 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2180 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2181 };
2182
2183 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2184 {
2185 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2186 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2187 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2188 NULL, /* 'e' */
2189 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2190 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2191 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2192 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2193 NULL, /* 'j' */
2194 NULL, /* 'k' */
2195 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2196 NULL, /* 'm' */
2197 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2198 NULL, /* 'o' */
2199 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2200 NULL, /* 'q' */
2201 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2202 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2203 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2204 NULL, /* 'u' */
2205 NULL, /* 'v' */
2206 NULL, /* 'w' */
2207 NULL, /* 'x' */
2208 NULL, /* 'y' */
2209 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2210 };
2211
2212 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2213 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2214 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2215 unsigned int rela)
2216 {
2217 int i;
2218 int len;
2219
2220 len = strlen (name);
2221
2222 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2223 {
2224 int suffix_len;
2225 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2226
2227 if (len < prefix_len)
2228 continue;
2229 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2230 continue;
2231
2232 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2233 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2234 {
2235 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2236 {
2237 if (suffix_len == 0)
2238 continue;
2239 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2240 && (suffix_len == -2
2241 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2242 continue;
2243 }
2244 }
2245 else
2246 {
2247 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2248 continue;
2249 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2250 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2251 suffix_len) != 0)
2252 continue;
2253 }
2254 return &spec[i];
2255 }
2256
2257 return NULL;
2258 }
2259
2260 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2261 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2262 {
2263 int i;
2264 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2265 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2266
2267 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2268 if (sec->name == NULL)
2269 return NULL;
2270
2271 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2272 spec = bed->special_sections;
2273 if (spec)
2274 {
2275 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2276 bed->special_sections,
2277 sec->use_rela_p);
2278 if (spec != NULL)
2279 return spec;
2280 }
2281
2282 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2283 return NULL;
2284
2285 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2286 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2287 return NULL;
2288
2289 spec = special_sections[i];
2290
2291 if (spec == NULL)
2292 return NULL;
2293
2294 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2295 }
2296
2297 bfd_boolean
2298 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2299 {
2300 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2301 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2302 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2303
2304 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2305 if (sdata == NULL)
2306 {
2307 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2308 sizeof (*sdata));
2309 if (sdata == NULL)
2310 return FALSE;
2311 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2312 }
2313
2314 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2315 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2316 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2317
2318 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2319 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2320 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2321 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2322 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2323 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2324 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2325 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2326 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2327 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2328 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2329 {
2330 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2331 if (ssect != NULL
2332 && (!sec->flags
2333 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2334 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2335 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2336 {
2337 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2338 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2339 }
2340 }
2341
2342 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2343 }
2344
2345 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2346
2347 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2348 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2349 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2350 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2351
2352 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2353 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2354 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2355 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2356 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2357 of combined data+bss.
2358
2359 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2360 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2361 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2362 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2363 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2364
2365 */
2366
2367 bfd_boolean
2368 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2369 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2370 int hdr_index,
2371 const char *type_name)
2372 {
2373 asection *newsect;
2374 char *name;
2375 char namebuf[64];
2376 size_t len;
2377 int split;
2378
2379 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2380 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2381 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2382
2383 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2384 {
2385 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2386 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2387 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2388 if (!name)
2389 return FALSE;
2390 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2391 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2392 if (newsect == NULL)
2393 return FALSE;
2394 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2395 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2396 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2397 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2398 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2399 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2400 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2401 {
2402 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2403 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2404 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2405 {
2406 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2407 may be data. */
2408 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2409 }
2410 }
2411 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2412 {
2413 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2414 }
2415 }
2416
2417 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2418 {
2419 bfd_vma align;
2420
2421 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2422 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2423 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2424 if (!name)
2425 return FALSE;
2426 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2427 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2428 if (newsect == NULL)
2429 return FALSE;
2430 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2431 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2432 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2433 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2434 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2435 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2436 align = hdr->p_align;
2437 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2438 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2439 {
2440 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2441 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2442 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2443 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2444 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2445 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2446 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2447 newsect->size = 0;
2448 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2449 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2450 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2451 }
2452 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2453 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2454 }
2455
2456 return TRUE;
2457 }
2458
2459 bfd_boolean
2460 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2461 {
2462 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2463
2464 switch (hdr->p_type)
2465 {
2466 case PT_NULL:
2467 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2468
2469 case PT_LOAD:
2470 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2471
2472 case PT_DYNAMIC:
2473 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2474
2475 case PT_INTERP:
2476 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2477
2478 case PT_NOTE:
2479 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2480 return FALSE;
2481 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2482 return FALSE;
2483 return TRUE;
2484
2485 case PT_SHLIB:
2486 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2487
2488 case PT_PHDR:
2489 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
2490
2491 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2492 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
2493 "eh_frame_hdr");
2494
2495 case PT_GNU_STACK:
2496 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
2497
2498 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
2499 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
2500
2501 default:
2502 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
2503 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2504 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
2505 }
2506 }
2507
2508 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
2509 REL or RELA. */
2510
2511 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
2512 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
2513 {
2514 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
2515 {
2516 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
2517 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
2518 }
2519 else
2520 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
2521 }
2522
2523 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
2524 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
2525 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
2526 relocations. */
2527
2528 static bfd_boolean
2529 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2530 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
2531 asection *asect,
2532 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2533 {
2534 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
2535 char *name;
2536 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2537 bfd_size_type amt;
2538
2539 amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
2540 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
2541 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2542 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
2543
2544 amt = sizeof ".rela" + strlen (asect->name);
2545 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2546 if (name == NULL)
2547 return FALSE;
2548 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", asect->name);
2549 rel_hdr->sh_name =
2550 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2551 FALSE);
2552 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2553 return FALSE;
2554 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2555 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2556 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2557 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2558 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2559 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2560 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2561 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2562 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2563
2564 return TRUE;
2565 }
2566
2567 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
2568
2569 int
2570 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
2571 {
2572 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2573 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2574 return SHT_NOBITS;
2575 return SHT_PROGBITS;
2576 }
2577
2578 struct fake_section_arg
2579 {
2580 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
2581 bfd_boolean failed;
2582 };
2583
2584 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
2585
2586 static void
2587 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
2588 {
2589 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
2590 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2591 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
2592 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2593 unsigned int sh_type;
2594
2595 if (arg->failed)
2596 {
2597 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2598 loop. */
2599 return;
2600 }
2601
2602 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
2603
2604 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2605 asect->name, FALSE);
2606 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2607 {
2608 arg->failed = TRUE;
2609 return;
2610 }
2611
2612 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
2613
2614 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2615 || asect->user_set_vma)
2616 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2617 else
2618 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2619
2620 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2621 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2622 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2623 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2624 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2625 copy_private_section_data. */
2626
2627 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2628 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2629
2630 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
2631 asect->flags. */
2632 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
2633 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
2634 else
2635 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
2636
2637 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
2638 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2639 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
2640 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
2641 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2642 {
2643 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
2644 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
2645 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
2646 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
2647 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2648 (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
2649 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2650 }
2651
2652 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
2653 {
2654 default:
2655 break;
2656
2657 case SHT_STRTAB:
2658 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
2659 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
2660 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
2661 case SHT_NOTE:
2662 case SHT_NOBITS:
2663 case SHT_PROGBITS:
2664 break;
2665
2666 case SHT_HASH:
2667 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
2668 break;
2669
2670 case SHT_DYNSYM:
2671 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
2672 break;
2673
2674 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
2675 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
2676 break;
2677
2678 case SHT_RELA:
2679 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
2680 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2681 break;
2682
2683 case SHT_REL:
2684 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
2685 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
2686 break;
2687
2688 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2689 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
2690 break;
2691
2692 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2693 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2694 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2695 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
2696 zero. */
2697 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2698 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
2699 else
2700 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
2701 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
2702 break;
2703
2704 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2705 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2706 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2707 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
2708 zero. */
2709 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2710 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
2711 else
2712 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
2713 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
2714 break;
2715
2716 case SHT_GROUP:
2717 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
2718 break;
2719
2720 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
2721 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
2722 break;
2723 }
2724
2725 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2726 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
2727 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
2728 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
2729 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2730 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
2731 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
2732 {
2733 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
2734 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
2735 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
2736 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
2737 }
2738 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
2739 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
2740 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
2741 {
2742 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
2743 if (asect->size == 0
2744 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
2745 {
2746 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
2747
2748 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2749 if (o != NULL)
2750 {
2751 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
2752 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
2753 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
2754 }
2755 }
2756 }
2757 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
2758 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
2759
2760 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
2761 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
2762 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
2763 create the other. */
2764 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
2765 {
2766 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
2767 needed. */
2768 if (arg->link_info
2769 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
2770 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
2771 && (arg->link_info->relocatable || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
2772 {
2773 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
2774 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, asect, FALSE))
2775 {
2776 arg->failed = TRUE;
2777 return;
2778 }
2779 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
2780 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, asect, TRUE))
2781 {
2782 arg->failed = TRUE;
2783 return;
2784 }
2785 }
2786 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
2787 (asect->use_rela_p
2788 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
2789 asect,
2790 asect->use_rela_p))
2791 arg->failed = TRUE;
2792 }
2793
2794 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
2795 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
2796 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
2797 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
2798 arg->failed = TRUE;
2799
2800 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
2801 {
2802 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
2803 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
2804 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2805 }
2806 }
2807
2808 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
2809 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
2810 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
2811 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
2812
2813 void
2814 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
2815 {
2816 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
2817 asection *elt, *first;
2818 unsigned char *loc;
2819 bfd_boolean gas;
2820
2821 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
2822 elfxx-ia64.c. */
2823 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
2824 || *failedptr)
2825 return;
2826
2827 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
2828 {
2829 unsigned long symindx = 0;
2830
2831 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
2832 generic linker. */
2833 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
2834 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
2835
2836 if (symindx == 0)
2837 {
2838 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
2839 elf_section_syms. */
2840 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
2841 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
2842 }
2843 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
2844 }
2845 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
2846 {
2847 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
2848 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
2849 set until all local symbols are output. */
2850 asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
2851 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
2852 unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
2853 unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
2854 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2855
2856 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
2857 {
2858 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2859
2860 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
2861 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2862 }
2863 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
2864 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2865 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2866 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2867
2868 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
2869 }
2870
2871 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
2872 gas = TRUE;
2873 if (sec->contents == NULL)
2874 {
2875 gas = FALSE;
2876 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
2877
2878 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
2879 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
2880 if (sec->contents == NULL)
2881 {
2882 *failedptr = TRUE;
2883 return;
2884 }
2885 }
2886
2887 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
2888
2889 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
2890 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
2891 start of the input section group. */
2892 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
2893
2894 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
2895 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
2896 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
2897 directives, not that it matters. */
2898 while (elt != NULL)
2899 {
2900 asection *s;
2901
2902 s = elt;
2903 if (!gas)
2904 s = s->output_section;
2905 if (s != NULL
2906 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
2907 {
2908 unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
2909
2910 loc -= 4;
2911 H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
2912 }
2913 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
2914 if (elt == first)
2915 break;
2916 }
2917
2918 if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
2919 abort ();
2920
2921 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
2922 }
2923
2924 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
2925 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
2926 in here too, while we're at it. */
2927
2928 static bfd_boolean
2929 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
2930 {
2931 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
2932 asection *sec;
2933 unsigned int section_number, secn;
2934 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
2935 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
2936 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
2937
2938 section_number = 1;
2939
2940 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
2941
2942 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
2943 if (link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable)
2944 {
2945 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
2946 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2947 {
2948 d = elf_section_data (sec);
2949
2950 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
2951 {
2952 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
2953 {
2954 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
2955 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
2956 abfd->section_count--;
2957 }
2958 else
2959 d->this_idx = section_number++;
2960 }
2961 }
2962 }
2963
2964 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
2965 {
2966 d = elf_section_data (sec);
2967
2968 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
2969 d->this_idx = section_number++;
2970 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
2971 if (d->rel.hdr)
2972 {
2973 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
2974 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
2975 }
2976 else
2977 d->rel.idx = 0;
2978
2979 if (d->rela.hdr)
2980 {
2981 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
2982 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
2983 }
2984 else
2985 d->rela.idx = 0;
2986 }
2987
2988 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
2989 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
2990 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
2991
2992 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
2993 || (link_info == NULL
2994 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
2995 == HAS_RELOC)));
2996 if (need_symtab)
2997 {
2998 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
2999 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3000 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3001 {
3002 elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = section_number++;
3003 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
3004 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3005 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3006 if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3007 return FALSE;
3008 }
3009 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3010 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3011 }
3012
3013 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3014 {
3015 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3016 abfd, section_number);
3017 return FALSE;
3018 }
3019
3020 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3021 t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3022
3023 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3024 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3025
3026 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3027 indices. */
3028 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3029 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3030 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3031 return FALSE;
3032
3033 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3034 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3035 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3036 {
3037 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3038 return FALSE;
3039 }
3040
3041 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3042
3043 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3044 if (need_symtab)
3045 {
3046 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3047 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3048 {
3049 i_shdrp[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3050 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3051 }
3052 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3053 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3054 }
3055
3056 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3057 {
3058 asection *s;
3059 const char *name;
3060
3061 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3062
3063 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3064 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3065 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3066 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3067 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3068
3069 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3070
3071 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3072 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3073 the relocation entries apply. */
3074 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3075 {
3076 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3077 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3078 }
3079 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3080 {
3081 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3082 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3083 }
3084
3085 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3086 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3087 {
3088 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3089 if (s)
3090 {
3091 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3092 if (link_info != NULL)
3093 {
3094 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3095 if (discarded_section (s))
3096 {
3097 asection *kept;
3098 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3099 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3100 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3101 s, s->owner);
3102 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3103 size as the discarded one. */
3104 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3105 if (kept == NULL)
3106 {
3107 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3108 return FALSE;
3109 }
3110 s = kept;
3111 }
3112
3113 s = s->output_section;
3114 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3115 }
3116 else
3117 {
3118 /* Handle objcopy. */
3119 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3120 {
3121 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3122 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3123 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3124 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3125 return FALSE;
3126 }
3127 s = s->output_section;
3128 }
3129 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3130 }
3131 else
3132 {
3133 /* PR 290:
3134 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3135 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3136 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3137 where s is NULL. */
3138 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3139 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3140 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3141 bed->link_order_error_handler
3142 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3143 abfd, sec);
3144 }
3145 }
3146
3147 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3148 {
3149 case SHT_REL:
3150 case SHT_RELA:
3151 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3152 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3153 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3154 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3155 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3156 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3157 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3158 if (s != NULL)
3159 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3160
3161 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3162 name = sec->name;
3163 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL)
3164 name += 4;
3165 else
3166 name += 5;
3167 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3168 if (s != NULL)
3169 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3170 break;
3171
3172 case SHT_STRTAB:
3173 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3174 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3175 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3176 field to point to this section. */
3177 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3178 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3179 {
3180 size_t len;
3181 char *alc;
3182
3183 len = strlen (sec->name);
3184 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3185 if (alc == NULL)
3186 return FALSE;
3187 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3188 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3189 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3190 free (alc);
3191 if (s != NULL)
3192 {
3193 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3194
3195 /* This is a .stab section. */
3196 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3197 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3198 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3199 }
3200 }
3201 break;
3202
3203 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3204 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3205 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3206 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3207 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3208 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3209 version strings. */
3210 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3211 if (s != NULL)
3212 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3213 break;
3214
3215 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3216 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3217 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3218 the version strings. */
3219 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3220 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3221 if (s != NULL)
3222 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3223 break;
3224
3225 case SHT_HASH:
3226 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3227 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3228 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3229 this hash table or version table is for. */
3230 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3231 if (s != NULL)
3232 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3233 break;
3234
3235 case SHT_GROUP:
3236 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3237 }
3238 }
3239
3240 for (secn = 1; secn < section_number; ++secn)
3241 if (i_shdrp[secn] == NULL)
3242 i_shdrp[secn] = i_shdrp[0];
3243 else
3244 i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3245 i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name);
3246 return TRUE;
3247 }
3248
3249 static bfd_boolean
3250 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3251 {
3252 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3253 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3254 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3255 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3256
3257 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3258 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3259 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3260 }
3261
3262 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3263 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
3264
3265 static bfd_boolean
3266 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3267 {
3268 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
3269
3270 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
3271 return FALSE;
3272
3273 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
3274 return ((type_ptr != NULL
3275 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
3276 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3277 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3278 || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3279 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
3280 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
3281 }
3282
3283 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3284 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3285
3286 static bfd_boolean
3287 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
3288 {
3289 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3290 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3291 asymbol **sect_syms;
3292 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3293 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3294 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3295 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3296 int max_index = 0;
3297 unsigned int idx;
3298 asection *asect;
3299 asymbol **new_syms;
3300
3301 #ifdef DEBUG
3302 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3303 fflush (stderr);
3304 #endif
3305
3306 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3307 {
3308 if (max_index < asect->index)
3309 max_index = asect->index;
3310 }
3311
3312 max_index++;
3313 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3314 if (sect_syms == NULL)
3315 return FALSE;
3316 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3317 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3318
3319 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3320 decided to output. */
3321 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3322 {
3323 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3324
3325 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3326 && sym->value == 0
3327 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
3328 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3329 {
3330 asection *sec = sym->section;
3331
3332 if (sec->owner != abfd)
3333 sec = sec->output_section;
3334
3335 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3336 }
3337 }
3338
3339 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
3340 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3341 {
3342 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3343 num_globals++;
3344 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3345 num_locals++;
3346 }
3347
3348 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
3349 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3350 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3351 at least in that case. */
3352 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3353 {
3354 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3355 {
3356 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3357 num_locals++;
3358 else
3359 num_globals++;
3360 }
3361 }
3362
3363 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
3364 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
3365 sizeof (asymbol *));
3366
3367 if (new_syms == NULL)
3368 return FALSE;
3369
3370 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3371 {
3372 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3373 unsigned int i;
3374
3375 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3376 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3377 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3378 i = num_locals2++;
3379 else
3380 continue;
3381 new_syms[i] = sym;
3382 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3383 }
3384 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3385 {
3386 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3387 {
3388 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3389 unsigned int i;
3390
3391 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3392 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3393 i = num_locals2++;
3394 else
3395 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3396 new_syms[i] = sym;
3397 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3398 }
3399 }
3400
3401 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3402
3403 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
3404 return TRUE;
3405 }
3406
3407 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3408 ELF data structure. */
3409
3410 static inline file_ptr
3411 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3412 {
3413 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3414 }
3415
3416 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3417 required section alignment. */
3418
3419 file_ptr
3420 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3421 file_ptr offset,
3422 bfd_boolean align)
3423 {
3424 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
3425 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
3426 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3427 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3428 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3429 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3430 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3431 return offset;
3432 }
3433
3434 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3435 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
3436 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
3437
3438 bfd_boolean
3439 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3440 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3441 {
3442 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3443 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
3444 bfd_boolean failed;
3445 struct bfd_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3446 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3447 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3448
3449 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3450 return TRUE;
3451
3452 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
3453 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3454 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3455
3456 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3457 return FALSE;
3458
3459 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
3460 if (bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers)
3461 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3462
3463 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
3464 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
3465 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
3466 if (fsargs.failed)
3467 return FALSE;
3468
3469 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3470 return FALSE;
3471
3472 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
3473 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
3474 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3475 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3476 == HAS_RELOC)));
3477 if (need_symtab)
3478 {
3479 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
3480 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3481
3482 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3483 return FALSE;
3484 }
3485
3486 failed = FALSE;
3487 if (link_info == NULL)
3488 {
3489 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3490 if (failed)
3491 return FALSE;
3492 }
3493
3494 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3495 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
3496 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3497 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3498 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3499 shstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3500 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3501 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3502 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3503 /* sh_offset is set in assign_file_positions_except_relocs. */
3504 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3505
3506 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3507 return FALSE;
3508
3509 if (need_symtab)
3510 {
3511 file_ptr off;
3512 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3513
3514 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
3515
3516 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3517 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3518
3519 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3520 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3521 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3522
3523 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3524 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3525
3526 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
3527
3528 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3529 out. */
3530 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3531 || ! _bfd_stringtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3532 return FALSE;
3533 _bfd_stringtab_free (strtab);
3534 }
3535
3536 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3537
3538 return TRUE;
3539 }
3540
3541 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
3542 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
3543
3544 static bfd_size_type
3545 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3546 {
3547 size_t segs;
3548 asection *s;
3549 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3550
3551 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3552 and one for data. */
3553 segs = 2;
3554
3555 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3556 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3557 {
3558 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3559 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
3560 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3561 targets. */
3562 segs += 2;
3563 }
3564
3565 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3566 {
3567 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3568 ++segs;
3569 }
3570
3571 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
3572 {
3573 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
3574 ++segs;
3575 }
3576
3577 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
3578 {
3579 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
3580 ++segs;
3581 }
3582
3583 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
3584 {
3585 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
3586 ++segs;
3587 }
3588
3589 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3590 {
3591 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3592 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
3593 {
3594 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
3595 ++segs;
3596 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
3597 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
3598 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
3599 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
3600 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
3601 so we check whether the sections are correctly
3602 aligned. */
3603 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
3604 while (s->next != NULL
3605 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
3606 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3607 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
3608 s = s->next;
3609 }
3610 }
3611
3612 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3613 {
3614 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3615 {
3616 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
3617 ++segs;
3618 break;
3619 }
3620 }
3621
3622 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
3623 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3624 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
3625 {
3626 int a;
3627
3628 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
3629 if (a == -1)
3630 abort ();
3631 segs += a;
3632 }
3633
3634 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
3635 }
3636
3637 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
3638
3639 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
3640 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
3641 {
3642 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3643 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
3644
3645 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
3646 m != NULL;
3647 m = m->next, p++)
3648 {
3649 int i;
3650
3651 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3652 if (m->sections[i] == section)
3653 return p;
3654 }
3655
3656 return NULL;
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
3660
3661 static struct elf_segment_map *
3662 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
3663 asection **sections,
3664 unsigned int from,
3665 unsigned int to,
3666 bfd_boolean phdr)
3667 {
3668 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3669 unsigned int i;
3670 asection **hdrpp;
3671 bfd_size_type amt;
3672
3673 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3674 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
3675 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3676 if (m == NULL)
3677 return NULL;
3678 m->next = NULL;
3679 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
3680 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
3681 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
3682 m->count = to - from;
3683
3684 if (from == 0 && phdr)
3685 {
3686 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
3687 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
3688 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3689 }
3690
3691 return m;
3692 }
3693
3694 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
3695 on failure. */
3696
3697 struct elf_segment_map *
3698 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
3699 {
3700 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3701
3702 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3703 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
3704 if (m == NULL)
3705 return NULL;
3706 m->next = NULL;
3707 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
3708 m->count = 1;
3709 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
3710
3711 return m;
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
3715
3716 static bfd_boolean
3717 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
3718 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3719 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
3720 {
3721 struct elf_segment_map **m;
3722 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3723
3724 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
3725 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
3726 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
3727 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
3728 removed. */
3729 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
3730 while (*m)
3731 {
3732 unsigned int i, new_count;
3733
3734 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
3735 {
3736 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3737 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3738 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
3739 {
3740 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
3741 new_count++;
3742 }
3743 }
3744 (*m)->count = new_count;
3745
3746 if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
3747 *m = (*m)->next;
3748 else
3749 m = &(*m)->next;
3750 }
3751
3752 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3753 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
3754 {
3755 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
3756 return FALSE;
3757 }
3758
3759 return TRUE;
3760 }
3761
3762 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
3763
3764 bfd_boolean
3765 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3766 {
3767 unsigned int count;
3768 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3769 asection **sections = NULL;
3770 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3771 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
3772
3773 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
3774
3775 if (info != NULL)
3776 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
3777
3778 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
3779 {
3780 asection *s;
3781 unsigned int i;
3782 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
3783 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
3784 asection *last_hdr;
3785 bfd_vma last_size;
3786 unsigned int phdr_index;
3787 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
3788 asection **hdrpp;
3789 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
3790 bfd_boolean writable;
3791 int tls_count = 0;
3792 asection *first_tls = NULL;
3793 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
3794 bfd_size_type amt;
3795 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
3796
3797 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
3798
3799 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
3800 sizeof (asection *));
3801 if (sections == NULL)
3802 goto error_return;
3803
3804 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
3805 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
3806 being shifted. */
3807 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
3808 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
3809
3810 i = 0;
3811 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3812 {
3813 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3814 {
3815 sections[i] = s;
3816 ++i;
3817 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
3818 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
3819 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
3820 }
3821 }
3822 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
3823 count = i;
3824
3825 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
3826
3827 /* Build the mapping. */
3828
3829 mfirst = NULL;
3830 pm = &mfirst;
3831
3832 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
3833 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
3834 section. */
3835 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3836 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3837 {
3838 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3839 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3840 if (m == NULL)
3841 goto error_return;
3842 m->next = NULL;
3843 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
3844 /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
3845 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
3846 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
3847 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3848
3849 *pm = m;
3850 pm = &m->next;
3851
3852 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3853 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3854 if (m == NULL)
3855 goto error_return;
3856 m->next = NULL;
3857 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
3858 m->count = 1;
3859 m->sections[0] = s;
3860
3861 *pm = m;
3862 pm = &m->next;
3863 }
3864
3865 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
3866 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
3867 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
3868 last_hdr = NULL;
3869 last_size = 0;
3870 phdr_index = 0;
3871 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
3872 writable = FALSE;
3873 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
3874 if (dynsec != NULL
3875 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
3876 dynsec = NULL;
3877
3878 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
3879 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
3880 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
3881 program headers we will need. */
3882 if (count > 0)
3883 {
3884 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
3885
3886 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
3887 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
3888 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
3889 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
3890 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
3891 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
3892 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
3893 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
3894 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3895 }
3896
3897 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
3898 {
3899 asection *hdr;
3900 bfd_boolean new_segment;
3901
3902 hdr = *hdrpp;
3903
3904 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
3905 segment. */
3906
3907 if (last_hdr == NULL)
3908 {
3909 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
3910 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
3911 new_segment = FALSE;
3912 }
3913 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
3914 {
3915 /* If this section has a different relation between the
3916 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
3917 segment. */
3918 new_segment = TRUE;
3919 }
3920 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
3921 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
3922 {
3923 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
3924 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
3925 new_segment = TRUE;
3926 }
3927 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
3928 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
3929 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
3930 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
3931 section can be included in the current segment. */
3932 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3933 > last_hdr->lma)
3934 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
3935 <= hdr->lma))
3936 {
3937 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
3938 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
3939 new_segment = TRUE;
3940 }
3941 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
3942 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
3943 {
3944 /* We don't want to put a loadable section after a
3945 nonloadable section in the same segment.
3946 Consider .tbss sections as loadable for this purpose. */
3947 new_segment = TRUE;
3948 }
3949 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
3950 {
3951 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
3952 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
3953 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
3954 new_segment = FALSE;
3955 }
3956 else if (! writable
3957 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
3958 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
3959 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
3960 {
3961 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
3962 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
3963 anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
3964 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
3965 only case in which the new section is not on the same
3966 page as the previous section is when the previous section
3967 ends precisely on a page boundary. */
3968 new_segment = TRUE;
3969 }
3970 else
3971 {
3972 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
3973 new_segment = FALSE;
3974 }
3975
3976 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
3977 if (last_hdr != NULL
3978 && info != NULL
3979 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
3980 new_segment
3981 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
3982 last_hdr,
3983 new_segment);
3984
3985 if (! new_segment)
3986 {
3987 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3988 writable = TRUE;
3989 last_hdr = hdr;
3990 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
3991 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
3992 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3993 last_size = hdr->size;
3994 else
3995 last_size = 0;
3996 continue;
3997 }
3998
3999 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4000 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4001
4002 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4003 if (m == NULL)
4004 goto error_return;
4005
4006 *pm = m;
4007 pm = &m->next;
4008
4009 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4010 writable = TRUE;
4011 else
4012 writable = FALSE;
4013
4014 last_hdr = hdr;
4015 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4016 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4017 last_size = hdr->size;
4018 else
4019 last_size = 0;
4020 phdr_index = i;
4021 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4022 }
4023
4024 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4025 for .tbss. */
4026 if (last_hdr != NULL
4027 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4028 || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4029 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4030 {
4031 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4032 if (m == NULL)
4033 goto error_return;
4034
4035 *pm = m;
4036 pm = &m->next;
4037 }
4038
4039 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4040 if (dynsec != NULL)
4041 {
4042 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4043 if (m == NULL)
4044 goto error_return;
4045 *pm = m;
4046 pm = &m->next;
4047 }
4048
4049 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4050 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4051 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4052 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4053 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4054 bogus anyhow. */
4055 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4056 {
4057 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4058 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4059 {
4060 asection *s2;
4061
4062 count = 1;
4063 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4064 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4065 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4066 {
4067 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4068 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4069 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4070 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4071 == s2->next->lma)
4072 count++;
4073 else
4074 break;
4075 }
4076 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4077 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4078 if (m == NULL)
4079 goto error_return;
4080 m->next = NULL;
4081 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4082 m->count = count;
4083 while (count > 1)
4084 {
4085 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4086 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4087 s = s->next;
4088 }
4089 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4090 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4091 *pm = m;
4092 pm = &m->next;
4093 }
4094 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4095 {
4096 if (! tls_count)
4097 first_tls = s;
4098 tls_count++;
4099 }
4100 }
4101
4102 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4103 if (tls_count > 0)
4104 {
4105 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4106 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4107 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4108 if (m == NULL)
4109 goto error_return;
4110 m->next = NULL;
4111 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4112 m->count = tls_count;
4113 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4114 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4115 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4116 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4117 {
4118 BFD_ASSERT (first_tls->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL);
4119 m->sections[i] = first_tls;
4120 first_tls = first_tls->next;
4121 }
4122
4123 *pm = m;
4124 pm = &m->next;
4125 }
4126
4127 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4128 segment. */
4129 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
4130 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4131 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4132 {
4133 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4134 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4135 if (m == NULL)
4136 goto error_return;
4137 m->next = NULL;
4138 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4139 m->count = 1;
4140 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4141
4142 *pm = m;
4143 pm = &m->next;
4144 }
4145
4146 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4147 {
4148 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4149 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4150 if (m == NULL)
4151 goto error_return;
4152 m->next = NULL;
4153 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4154 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
4155 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
4156 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4157 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
4158 if (info->stacksize > 0)
4159 {
4160 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
4161 m->p_size_valid = 1;
4162 }
4163
4164 *pm = m;
4165 pm = &m->next;
4166 }
4167
4168 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4169 {
4170 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4171 {
4172 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
4173 && m->count != 0
4174 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
4175 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
4176 {
4177 i = m->count;
4178 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
4179 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4180 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4181 break;
4182
4183 if (i == (unsigned) -1)
4184 continue;
4185
4186 if (m->sections[i]->vma + m->sections[i]->size
4187 >= info->relro_end)
4188 break;
4189 }
4190 }
4191
4192 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
4193 if (m != NULL)
4194 {
4195 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4196 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4197 if (m == NULL)
4198 goto error_return;
4199 m->next = NULL;
4200 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4201 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4202 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4203
4204 *pm = m;
4205 pm = &m->next;
4206 }
4207 }
4208
4209 free (sections);
4210 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
4211 }
4212
4213 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
4214 return FALSE;
4215
4216 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4217 ++count;
4218 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4219
4220 return TRUE;
4221
4222 error_return:
4223 if (sections != NULL)
4224 free (sections);
4225 return FALSE;
4226 }
4227
4228 /* Sort sections by address. */
4229
4230 static int
4231 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4232 {
4233 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4234 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4235 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4236
4237 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4238 place the section into a segment. */
4239 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4240 return -1;
4241 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4242 return 1;
4243
4244 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4245 the same, and this will do nothing. */
4246 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4247 return -1;
4248 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4249 return 1;
4250
4251 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
4252
4253 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4254
4255 if (TOEND (sec1))
4256 {
4257 if (TOEND (sec2))
4258 {
4259 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4260 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
4261 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4262 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4263 }
4264 else
4265 return 1;
4266 }
4267 else if (TOEND (sec2))
4268 return -1;
4269
4270 #undef TOEND
4271
4272 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4273 before others at the same address. */
4274
4275 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4276 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4277
4278 if (size1 < size2)
4279 return -1;
4280 if (size1 > size2)
4281 return 1;
4282
4283 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4284 }
4285
4286 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4287
4288 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
4289 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
4290 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
4291 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
4292 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4293 which is wrong.
4294
4295 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4296 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4297 the page size.'' */
4298 /* In other words, something like:
4299
4300 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4301 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4302 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4303 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4304 else
4305 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4306
4307 which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
4308
4309 static file_ptr
4310 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4311 {
4312 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4313 }
4314
4315 static void
4316 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
4317 {
4318 unsigned int j;
4319 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
4320 char buf[32];
4321
4322 if (pt == NULL)
4323 {
4324 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
4325 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
4326 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
4327 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
4328 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
4329 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
4330 else
4331 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
4332 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
4333 pt = buf;
4334 }
4335 fflush (stdout);
4336 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
4337 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
4338 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
4339 putc ('\n',stderr);
4340 fflush (stderr);
4341 }
4342
4343 static bfd_boolean
4344 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
4345 {
4346 void *buf;
4347 bfd_boolean ret;
4348
4349 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
4350 return FALSE;
4351 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
4352 if (buf == NULL)
4353 return FALSE;
4354 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
4355 free (buf);
4356 return ret;
4357 }
4358
4359 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4360 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
4361 the file header. */
4362
4363 static bfd_boolean
4364 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4365 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4366 {
4367 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4368 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4369 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4370 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4371 file_ptr off;
4372 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4373 unsigned int alloc;
4374 unsigned int i, j;
4375 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
4376
4377 if (link_info == NULL
4378 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
4379 return FALSE;
4380
4381 alloc = 0;
4382 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4383 {
4384 ++alloc;
4385 if (m->header_size)
4386 header_pad = m->header_size;
4387 }
4388
4389 if (alloc)
4390 {
4391 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4392 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4393 }
4394 else
4395 {
4396 /* PR binutils/12467. */
4397 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
4398 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
4399 }
4400
4401 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4402
4403 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4404 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4405 else
4406 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
4407 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4408
4409 if (alloc == 0)
4410 {
4411 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4412 return TRUE;
4413 }
4414
4415 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
4416 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
4417 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
4418 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
4419 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
4420 layout.
4421 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
4422 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
4423 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
4424 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
4425 == 0);
4426 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
4427 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
4428 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
4429 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4430 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4431 if (phdrs == NULL)
4432 return FALSE;
4433
4434 maxpagesize = 1;
4435 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4436 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4437
4438 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4439 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4440 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
4441 header_pad = 0;
4442 else
4443 header_pad -= off;
4444 off += header_pad;
4445
4446 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
4447 m != NULL;
4448 m = m->next, p++, j++)
4449 {
4450 asection **secpp;
4451 bfd_vma off_adjust;
4452 bfd_boolean no_contents;
4453
4454 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4455 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
4456 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4457 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4458 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
4459 if (m->count > 1
4460 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4461 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4462 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4463 elf_sort_sections);
4464
4465 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4466 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4467 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4468 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
4469 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
4470 p->p_type = m->p_type;
4471 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4472
4473 if (m->count == 0)
4474 p->p_vaddr = 0;
4475 else
4476 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4477
4478 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4479 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4480 else if (m->count == 0)
4481 p->p_paddr = 0;
4482 else
4483 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4484
4485 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4486 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4487 {
4488 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4489 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
4490 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
4491 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4492 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4493 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4494 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4495 segment. */
4496 if (m->p_align_valid)
4497 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4498
4499 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4500 }
4501 else if (m->p_align_valid)
4502 p->p_align = m->p_align;
4503 else if (m->count == 0)
4504 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4505 else
4506 p->p_align = 0;
4507
4508 no_contents = FALSE;
4509 off_adjust = 0;
4510 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4511 && m->count > 0)
4512 {
4513 bfd_size_type align;
4514 unsigned int align_power = 0;
4515
4516 if (m->p_align_valid)
4517 align = p->p_align;
4518 else
4519 {
4520 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4521 {
4522 unsigned int secalign;
4523
4524 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4525 if (secalign > align_power)
4526 align_power = secalign;
4527 }
4528 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4529 if (align < maxpagesize)
4530 align = maxpagesize;
4531 }
4532
4533 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4534 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4535 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4536 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4537 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
4538 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4539
4540 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4541 sections. */
4542 no_contents = TRUE;
4543 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4544 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
4545 {
4546 no_contents = FALSE;
4547 break;
4548 }
4549
4550 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
4551 off += off_adjust;
4552 if (no_contents)
4553 {
4554 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
4555 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
4556 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
4557 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
4558 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
4559 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
4560 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
4561 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
4562 }
4563 else
4564 off_adjust = 0;
4565 }
4566 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
4567 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4568 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
4569 && m->count > 1
4570 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
4571 {
4572 _bfd_error_handler
4573 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
4574 abfd);
4575 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4576 return FALSE;
4577 }
4578 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
4579 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
4580 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4581 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
4582
4583 p->p_offset = 0;
4584 p->p_filesz = 0;
4585 p->p_memsz = 0;
4586
4587 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4588 {
4589 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4590 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4591 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4592 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4593 if (m->count > 0)
4594 {
4595 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
4596 {
4597 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4598 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
4599 abfd);
4600 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4601 return FALSE;
4602 }
4603
4604 p->p_vaddr -= off;
4605 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4606 p->p_paddr -= off;
4607 }
4608 }
4609
4610 if (m->includes_phdrs)
4611 {
4612 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4613 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4614
4615 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
4616 {
4617 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4618
4619 if (m->count > 0)
4620 {
4621 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4622 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4623 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4624 }
4625 }
4626
4627 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4628 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4629 if (m->count)
4630 {
4631 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
4632 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
4633 }
4634 }
4635
4636 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4637 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
4638 {
4639 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
4640 p->p_offset = off;
4641 else
4642 {
4643 file_ptr adjust;
4644
4645 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
4646 if (!no_contents)
4647 p->p_filesz += adjust;
4648 p->p_memsz += adjust;
4649 }
4650 }
4651
4652 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
4653 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
4654 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
4655 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
4656 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
4657 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4658 {
4659 asection *sec;
4660 bfd_size_type align;
4661 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4662
4663 sec = *secpp;
4664 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
4665 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
4666
4667 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4668 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4669 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
4670 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
4671 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
4672 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
4673 {
4674 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
4675 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
4676 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
4677 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
4678
4679 if (adjust != 0
4680 && (s_start < p_end
4681 || p_end < p_start))
4682 {
4683 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4684 (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
4685 (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
4686 adjust = 0;
4687 sec->lma = p_end;
4688 }
4689 p->p_memsz += adjust;
4690
4691 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4692 {
4693 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
4694 {
4695 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
4696 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
4697 zero it. */
4698 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
4699 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
4700 return FALSE;
4701 }
4702 off += adjust;
4703 p->p_filesz += adjust;
4704 }
4705 }
4706
4707 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
4708 {
4709 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
4710 everything. */
4711 if (i == 0)
4712 {
4713 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4714 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4715 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
4716 p->p_memsz = 0;
4717 p->p_align = 1;
4718 }
4719 else
4720 {
4721 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
4722 sec->filepos = 0;
4723 sec->size = 0;
4724 sec->flags = 0;
4725 continue;
4726 }
4727 }
4728 else
4729 {
4730 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4731 {
4732 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4733 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4734 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4735 }
4736 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4737 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
4738 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
4739 {
4740 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
4741 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
4742 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
4743 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
4744 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
4745 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
4746 p_offset value. */
4747 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
4748 off, align);
4749 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
4750 }
4751
4752 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4753 {
4754 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4755 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
4756 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
4757 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
4758 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4759 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4760 }
4761 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4762 {
4763 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4764 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4765
4766 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
4767 normal segments. */
4768 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
4769 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4770 }
4771
4772 if (align > p->p_align
4773 && !m->p_align_valid
4774 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4775 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
4776 p->p_align = align;
4777 }
4778
4779 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4780 {
4781 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4782 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
4783 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
4784 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
4785 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
4786 }
4787 }
4788 off -= off_adjust;
4789
4790 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
4791 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
4792 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4793 {
4794 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
4795
4796 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
4797 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
4798 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
4799 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
4800 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
4801 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
4802 {
4803 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
4804 check_vma = FALSE;
4805 break;
4806 }
4807
4808 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4809 {
4810 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4811 asection *sec;
4812
4813 sec = m->sections[i];
4814 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
4815 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
4816 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
4817 {
4818 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4819 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
4820 abfd, sec, j);
4821 print_segment_map (m);
4822 }
4823 }
4824 }
4825 }
4826
4827 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4828 return TRUE;
4829 }
4830
4831 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
4832
4833 static bfd_boolean
4834 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4835 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4836 {
4837 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4838 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
4839 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4840 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4841 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4842 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4843 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
4844 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
4845 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
4846 file_ptr off;
4847 unsigned int num_sec;
4848 unsigned int i;
4849 unsigned int count;
4850
4851 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4852 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4853 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4854 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
4855 {
4856 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4857
4858 hdr = *hdrpp;
4859 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4860 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
4861 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4862 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
4863 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
4864 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4865 {
4866 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4867 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4868 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
4869 abfd,
4870 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
4871 ? "*unknown*"
4872 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
4873 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
4874 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
4875 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4876 bed->maxpagesize);
4877 else
4878 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4879 hdr->sh_addralign);
4880 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
4881 FALSE);
4882 }
4883 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
4884 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
4885 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
4886 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]
4887 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)])
4888 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
4889 else
4890 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4891 }
4892
4893 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
4894 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
4895 count = 0;
4896 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
4897 filehdr_paddr = 0;
4898 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4899 phdrs_paddr = 0;
4900 hdrs_segment = NULL;
4901 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4902 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
4903 {
4904 ++count;
4905 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
4906 continue;
4907
4908 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4909 {
4910 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4911 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4912 }
4913 if (m->includes_phdrs)
4914 {
4915 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4916 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4917 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4918 {
4919 hdrs_segment = m;
4920 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4921 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4922 }
4923 }
4924 }
4925
4926 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
4927 {
4928 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
4929 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
4930 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
4931
4932 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
4933 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
4934 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4935 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
4936 if (hash != NULL
4937 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
4938 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
4939 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4940 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
4941 {
4942 asection *s = NULL;
4943 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
4944 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
4945 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
4946 else
4947 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
4948 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4949 if (m->count != 0)
4950 {
4951 s = m->sections[0];
4952 break;
4953 }
4954
4955 if (s != NULL)
4956 {
4957 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
4958 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
4959 }
4960 else
4961 {
4962 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
4963 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
4964 }
4965
4966 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4967 hash->def_regular = 1;
4968 hash->non_elf = 0;
4969 }
4970 }
4971
4972 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
4973 {
4974 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
4975 {
4976 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
4977 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
4978
4979 if (link_info != NULL)
4980 {
4981 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
4982 in link_info. */
4983 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
4984 lm != NULL;
4985 lm = lm->next, lp++)
4986 {
4987 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4988 && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
4989 && lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz >= link_info->relro_end
4990 && lm->count != 0
4991 && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
4992 break;
4993 }
4994
4995 /* PR ld/14207. If the RELRO segment doesn't fit in the
4996 LOAD segment, it should be removed. */
4997 BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
4998 }
4999 else
5000 {
5001 /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5002 library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5003 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5004 {
5005 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5006 && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5007 break;
5008 }
5009 }
5010
5011 if (lp < phdrs + count)
5012 {
5013 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5014 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5015 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5016 if (link_info != NULL)
5017 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5018 else if (m->p_size_valid)
5019 p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5020 else
5021 abort ();
5022 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5023 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5024 gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5025 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5026 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5027 */
5028 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5029 p->p_align = 1;
5030 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5031 p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
5032 }
5033 else
5034 {
5035 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5036 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5037 }
5038 }
5039 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5040 {
5041 if (m->p_size_valid)
5042 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5043 }
5044 else if (m->count != 0)
5045 {
5046 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5047 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5048 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5049 {
5050 BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
5051
5052 p->p_filesz = 0;
5053 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5054 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5055 {
5056 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5057 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5058 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5059 {
5060 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5061 + hdr->sh_size);
5062 break;
5063 }
5064 }
5065 }
5066 }
5067 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5068 {
5069 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5070 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5071 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5072 }
5073 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5074 {
5075 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5076 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5077 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5078 }
5079 }
5080
5081 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5082
5083 return TRUE;
5084 }
5085
5086 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5087 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
5088 VMAs must be known before this is called.
5089
5090 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
5091 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
5092 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
5093 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
5094 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
5095 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
5096 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
5097
5098 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
5099
5100 static bfd_boolean
5101 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
5102 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5103 {
5104 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
5105 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5106 file_ptr off;
5107 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5108
5109 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5110 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5111 {
5112 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5113 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5114 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
5115 unsigned int i;
5116
5117 /* Start after the ELF header. */
5118 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
5119
5120 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5121 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5122 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
5123 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5124 {
5125 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5126
5127 hdr = *hdrpp;
5128 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5129 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5130 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
5131 || i == elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)
5132 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd))
5133 {
5134 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5135 }
5136 else
5137 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5138 }
5139 }
5140 else
5141 {
5142 unsigned int alloc;
5143
5144 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
5145 assignment of sections to segments. */
5146 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5147 return FALSE;
5148
5149 /* And for non-load sections. */
5150 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5151 return FALSE;
5152
5153 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
5154 {
5155 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
5156 return FALSE;
5157 }
5158
5159 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
5160 if (link_info != NULL
5161 && link_info->executable
5162 && link_info->shared)
5163 {
5164 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
5165 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5166 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
5167
5168 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
5169 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
5170 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
5171 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
5172 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5173
5174 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
5175 segments is non-zero. */
5176 if (p_vaddr)
5177 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5178 }
5179
5180 /* Write out the program headers. */
5181 alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5182 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
5183 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
5184 return FALSE;
5185
5186 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5187 }
5188
5189 /* Place the section headers. */
5190 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
5191 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
5192 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
5193
5194 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5195
5196 return TRUE;
5197 }
5198
5199 static bfd_boolean
5200 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
5201 {
5202 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
5203 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
5204 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5205
5206 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5207
5208 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
5209 if (shstrtab == NULL)
5210 return FALSE;
5211
5212 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
5213
5214 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
5215 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
5216 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
5217 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
5218
5219 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
5220 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
5221 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
5222 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
5223
5224 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5225 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
5226 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
5227 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5228 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5229 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
5230 else
5231 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
5232
5233 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
5234 {
5235 case bfd_arch_unknown:
5236 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
5237 break;
5238
5239 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5240 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5241 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
5242 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
5243 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5244 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5245 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5246 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
5247 default:
5248 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5249 }
5250
5251 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5252 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5253
5254 /* No program header, for now. */
5255 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5256 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5257 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5258
5259 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
5260 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5261 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5262
5263 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
5264 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5265 /* It all happens later. */
5266 ;
5267 else
5268 {
5269 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5270 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5271 }
5272
5273 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5274 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5275 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5276 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5277 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5278 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5279 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5280 || elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5281 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5282 return FALSE;
5283
5284 return TRUE;
5285 }
5286
5287 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5288 of the loadable file image. */
5289
5290 void
5291 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (bfd *abfd)
5292 {
5293 file_ptr off;
5294 unsigned int i, num_sec;
5295 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp;
5296
5297 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5298
5299 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5300 for (i = 1, shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; i < num_sec; i++, shdrpp++)
5301 {
5302 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5303
5304 shdrp = *shdrpp;
5305 if ((shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5306 && shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5307 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5308 }
5309
5310 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5311 }
5312
5313 bfd_boolean
5314 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5315 {
5316 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5317 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5318 bfd_boolean failed;
5319 unsigned int count, num_sec;
5320 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
5321
5322 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5323 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5324 return FALSE;
5325
5326 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5327
5328 failed = FALSE;
5329 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5330 if (failed)
5331 return FALSE;
5332
5333 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (abfd);
5334
5335 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
5336 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5337 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5338 {
5339 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5340 (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5341 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5342 {
5343 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5344
5345 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5346 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5347 return FALSE;
5348 }
5349 }
5350
5351 /* Write out the section header names. */
5352 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
5353 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5354 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5355 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5356 return FALSE;
5357
5358 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5359 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
5360
5361 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
5362 return FALSE;
5363
5364 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
5365 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
5366 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
5367
5368 return TRUE;
5369 }
5370
5371 bfd_boolean
5372 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5373 {
5374 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
5375 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
5379
5380 unsigned int
5381 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5382 {
5383 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5384 unsigned int sec_index;
5385
5386 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5387 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5388 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5389
5390 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5391 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
5392 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5393 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
5394 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5395 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
5396 else
5397 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
5398
5399 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5400 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5401 {
5402 int retval = sec_index;
5403
5404 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5405 return retval;
5406 }
5407
5408 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
5409 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5410
5411 return sec_index;
5412 }
5413
5414 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5415 on error. */
5416
5417 int
5418 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5419 {
5420 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5421 int idx;
5422 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5423
5424 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5425 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5426 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
5427 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5428 input sections rather than the output section. */
5429 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5430 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5431 && asym_ptr->section)
5432 {
5433 asection *sec;
5434 int indx;
5435
5436 sec = asym_ptr->section;
5437 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5438 sec = sec->output_section;
5439 if (sec->owner == abfd
5440 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5441 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5442 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5443 }
5444
5445 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5446
5447 if (idx == 0)
5448 {
5449 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5450 which is used in a relocation entry. */
5451 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5452 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5453 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5454 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5455 return -1;
5456 }
5457
5458 #if DEBUG & 4
5459 {
5460 fprintf (stderr,
5461 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
5462 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
5463 fflush (stderr);
5464 }
5465 #endif
5466
5467 return idx;
5468 }
5469
5470 /* Rewrite program header information. */
5471
5472 static bfd_boolean
5473 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5474 {
5475 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5476 struct elf_segment_map *map;
5477 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5478 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5479 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5480 asection *section;
5481 unsigned int i;
5482 unsigned int num_segments;
5483 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5484 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
5485 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
5486 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
5487 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
5488 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5489
5490 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
5491 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5492
5493 map_first = NULL;
5494 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5495
5496 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5497 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
5498
5499 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
5500 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
5501 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
5502 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
5503
5504 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
5505 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5506 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
5507 ? section->size : 0)
5508
5509 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5510 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
5511 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
5512 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
5513 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5514 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
5515
5516 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5517 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
5518 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
5519 (section->lma >= base \
5520 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5521 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
5522
5523 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
5524 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
5525 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
5526 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
5527 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5528 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5529 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5530
5531 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
5532 etc. */
5533 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
5534 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
5535 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
5536 && s->vma == 0 \
5537 && s->lma == 0)
5538
5539 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
5540 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
5541 p_memsz set to 0. */
5542 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
5543 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
5544 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
5545 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
5546 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
5547 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
5548 && s->size > 0 \
5549 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5550 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5551 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5552
5553 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
5554 A section will be included if:
5555 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
5556 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
5557 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
5558 segment.
5559 3. There is an output section associated with it,
5560 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
5561 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
5562 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
5563 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
5564 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
5565 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
5566 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5567 ((((segment->p_paddr \
5568 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
5569 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
5570 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
5571 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
5572 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
5573 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
5574 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5575 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
5576 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
5577 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
5578 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
5579 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
5580 || (segment->p_paddr \
5581 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
5582 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
5583 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
5584 == 0)) \
5585 && !section->segment_mark)
5586
5587 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
5588 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5589 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5590 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
5591 && section->output_section != NULL)
5592
5593 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
5594 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
5595 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
5596
5597 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
5598 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
5599 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
5600 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
5601 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
5602 LMA. */
5603 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
5604 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
5605 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
5606 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
5607 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
5608
5609 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
5610 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5611 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
5612
5613 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
5614 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
5615 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
5616 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
5617 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
5618 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5619 i < num_segments;
5620 i++, segment++)
5621 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
5622 {
5623 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
5624 break;
5625 }
5626
5627 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
5628 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
5629 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
5630 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
5631 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5632 i < num_segments;
5633 i++, segment++)
5634 {
5635 unsigned int j;
5636 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
5637
5638 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
5639 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
5640 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
5641 {
5642 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
5643 assignment code will work. */
5644 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
5645 break;
5646 }
5647
5648 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5649 {
5650 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
5651 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5652 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5653 continue;
5654 }
5655
5656 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
5657 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
5658 {
5659 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
5660
5661 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
5662 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
5663 continue;
5664
5665 /* Merge the two segments together. */
5666 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
5667 {
5668 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
5669 SEGMENT. */
5670 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
5671 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
5672
5673 if (extra_length > 0)
5674 {
5675 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
5676 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
5677 }
5678
5679 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5680
5681 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
5682 i = 0;
5683 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5684 break;
5685 }
5686 else
5687 {
5688 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
5689 SEGMENT2. */
5690 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
5691 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
5692
5693 if (extra_length > 0)
5694 {
5695 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
5696 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
5697 }
5698
5699 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
5700 }
5701 }
5702 }
5703
5704 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
5705 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5706 i < num_segments;
5707 i++, segment++)
5708 {
5709 unsigned int section_count;
5710 asection **sections;
5711 asection *output_section;
5712 unsigned int isec;
5713 bfd_vma matching_lma;
5714 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
5715 unsigned int j;
5716 bfd_size_type amt;
5717 asection *first_section;
5718 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
5719 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
5720
5721 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
5722 continue;
5723
5724 first_section = NULL;
5725 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
5726 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
5727 section != NULL;
5728 section = section->next)
5729 {
5730 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
5731 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5732 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5733 {
5734 if (first_section == NULL)
5735 first_section = section;
5736 if (section->output_section != NULL)
5737 ++section_count;
5738 }
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
5742 all of the sections we have selected. */
5743 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5744 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5745 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
5746 if (map == NULL)
5747 return FALSE;
5748
5749 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
5750 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
5751 map->next = NULL;
5752 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5753 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5754 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5755
5756 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
5757 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
5758 output segment. */
5759 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
5760 {
5761 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
5762 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
5763 }
5764
5765 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
5766 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
5767 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
5768 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
5769 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5770
5771 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5772 {
5773 map->includes_phdrs =
5774 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5775 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
5776 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5777 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
5778
5779 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
5780 phdr_included = TRUE;
5781 }
5782
5783 if (section_count == 0)
5784 {
5785 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
5786 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
5787 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
5788 a warning is produced. */
5789 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5790 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment"
5791 " detected, is this intentional ?\n"),
5792 ibfd);
5793
5794 map->count = 0;
5795 *pointer_to_map = map;
5796 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5797
5798 continue;
5799 }
5800
5801 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
5802 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
5803 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
5804 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
5805
5806 1. None of the sections have been moved.
5807 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
5808 input BFD.
5809
5810 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
5811 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5812 of the first section.
5813
5814 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
5815 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
5816 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
5817 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
5818 have to be created to contain the other sections.
5819
5820 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
5821 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5822 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
5823 or segments to contain the other sections.
5824
5825 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
5826 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
5827 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
5828
5829 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
5830 if (sections == NULL)
5831 return FALSE;
5832
5833 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
5834 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
5835 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
5836 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
5837 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
5838 more to do. */
5839 isec = 0;
5840 matching_lma = 0;
5841 suggested_lma = 0;
5842 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
5843 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5844
5845 for (section = ibfd->sections;
5846 section != NULL;
5847 section = section->next)
5848 if (section == first_section)
5849 break;
5850
5851 for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5852 {
5853 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5854 {
5855 output_section = section->output_section;
5856
5857 sections[j++] = section;
5858
5859 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
5860 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
5861 correct value. Note - some backends require that
5862 p_paddr be left as zero. */
5863 if (!p_paddr_valid
5864 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
5865 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5866 && isec == 0
5867 && output_section->lma != 0
5868 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
5869 + (map->includes_filehdr
5870 ? iehdr->e_ehsize
5871 : 0)
5872 + (map->includes_phdrs
5873 ? (iehdr->e_phnum
5874 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5875 : 0)))
5876 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5877
5878 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
5879 LMA address of the output section. */
5880 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5881 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
5882 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5883 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
5884 {
5885 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
5886 {
5887 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
5888 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
5889 }
5890
5891 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
5892 then it does not overlap any other section within that
5893 segment. */
5894 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
5895 }
5896 else if (first_suggested_lma)
5897 {
5898 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5899 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
5900 }
5901
5902 if (j == section_count)
5903 break;
5904 }
5905 }
5906
5907 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
5908
5909 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
5910 if necessary. */
5911 if (isec == section_count)
5912 {
5913 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
5914 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
5915 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
5916 program header in the input BFD. */
5917 map->count = section_count;
5918 *pointer_to_map = map;
5919 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5920
5921 if (p_paddr_valid
5922 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
5923 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
5924 && !map->includes_filehdr
5925 && !map->includes_phdrs)
5926 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
5927 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
5928 segment's vma. */
5929 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
5930
5931 free (sections);
5932 continue;
5933 }
5934 else
5935 {
5936 if (!first_matching_lma)
5937 {
5938 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
5939 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
5940 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
5941 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
5942 }
5943 else
5944 {
5945 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
5946 Change the current segment's physical address to match
5947 the LMA of the first section. */
5948 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5949 }
5950
5951 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
5952 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
5953 if (map->includes_filehdr)
5954 {
5955 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
5956 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
5957 else
5958 {
5959 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
5960 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5961 }
5962 }
5963
5964 if (map->includes_phdrs)
5965 {
5966 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5967 {
5968 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5969
5970 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
5971 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
5972 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
5973 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
5974 offset when we know the correct value. */
5975 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
5976 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
5977 }
5978 else
5979 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
5980 }
5981 }
5982
5983 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
5984 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
5985 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
5986 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
5987 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
5988 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
5989 the loop. */
5990 isec = 0;
5991 do
5992 {
5993 map->count = 0;
5994 suggested_lma = 0;
5995 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
5996
5997 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
5998 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
5999 {
6000 section = sections[j];
6001
6002 if (section == NULL)
6003 continue;
6004
6005 output_section = section->output_section;
6006
6007 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
6008
6009 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6010 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
6011 {
6012 if (map->count == 0)
6013 {
6014 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
6015 the beginning of the segment, then something is
6016 wrong. */
6017 if (output_section->lma
6018 != (map->p_paddr
6019 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6020 + (map->includes_phdrs
6021 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6022 : 0)))
6023 abort ();
6024 }
6025 else
6026 {
6027 asection *prev_sec;
6028
6029 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
6030
6031 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
6032 and the start of this section is more than
6033 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
6034 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
6035 maxpagesize)
6036 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
6037 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
6038 > output_section->lma))
6039 {
6040 if (first_suggested_lma)
6041 {
6042 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6043 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6044 }
6045
6046 continue;
6047 }
6048 }
6049
6050 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
6051 ++isec;
6052 sections[j] = NULL;
6053 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
6054 }
6055 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6056 {
6057 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6058 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6059 }
6060 }
6061
6062 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
6063
6064 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
6065 *pointer_to_map = map;
6066 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6067
6068 if (isec < section_count)
6069 {
6070 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
6071 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
6072 and carry on looping. */
6073 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6074 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6075 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6076 if (map == NULL)
6077 {
6078 free (sections);
6079 return FALSE;
6080 }
6081
6082 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
6083 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
6084 not yet been assigned. */
6085 map->next = NULL;
6086 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6087 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6088 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6089 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6090 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6091 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
6092 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6093 }
6094 }
6095 while (isec < section_count);
6096
6097 free (sections);
6098 }
6099
6100 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6101
6102 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
6103 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
6104 the offset if necessary. */
6105 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
6106 {
6107 unsigned int count;
6108
6109 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
6110 count++;
6111
6112 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
6113 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
6114 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6115 }
6116
6117 #undef SEGMENT_END
6118 #undef SECTION_SIZE
6119 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
6120 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
6121 #undef IS_NOTE
6122 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
6123 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
6124 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
6125 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
6126 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
6127 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
6128 return TRUE;
6129 }
6130
6131 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
6132
6133 static bfd_boolean
6134 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6135 {
6136 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6137 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6138 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6139 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6140 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6141 unsigned int i;
6142 unsigned int num_segments;
6143 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6144 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6145
6146 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6147
6148 map_first = NULL;
6149 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6150
6151 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
6152 map->p_paddr_valid. */
6153 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6154 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6155 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6156 i < num_segments;
6157 i++, segment++)
6158 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6159 {
6160 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6161 break;
6162 }
6163
6164 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6165 i < num_segments;
6166 i++, segment++)
6167 {
6168 asection *section;
6169 unsigned int section_count;
6170 bfd_size_type amt;
6171 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6172 asection *first_section = NULL;
6173 asection *lowest_section;
6174
6175 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
6176 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6177 section != NULL;
6178 section = section->next)
6179 {
6180 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6181 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6182 {
6183 if (first_section == NULL)
6184 first_section = section;
6185 section_count++;
6186 }
6187 }
6188
6189 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6190 all of the sections we have selected. */
6191 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6192 if (section_count != 0)
6193 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6194 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6195 if (map == NULL)
6196 return FALSE;
6197
6198 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
6199 input segment. */
6200 map->next = NULL;
6201 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6202 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6203 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6204 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6205 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6206 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
6207 map->p_align_valid = 1;
6208 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
6209
6210 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
6211 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6212 {
6213 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
6214 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
6215 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
6216 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
6217 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
6218 systems. */
6219 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
6220 map->p_size_valid = 1;
6221 }
6222
6223 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6224 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6225 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6226 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6227
6228 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6229 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6230 {
6231 map->includes_phdrs =
6232 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6233 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6234 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6235 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6236
6237 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6238 phdr_included = TRUE;
6239 }
6240
6241 lowest_section = first_section;
6242 if (section_count != 0)
6243 {
6244 unsigned int isec = 0;
6245
6246 for (section = first_section;
6247 section != NULL;
6248 section = section->next)
6249 {
6250 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6251 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6252 {
6253 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
6254 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6255 {
6256 bfd_vma seg_off;
6257
6258 if (section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
6259 lowest_section = section;
6260
6261 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
6262 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
6263 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
6264 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
6265 invalid. */
6266 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
6267 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
6268 else
6269 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
6270 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
6271 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6272 }
6273 if (isec == section_count)
6274 break;
6275 }
6276 }
6277 }
6278
6279 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
6280 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
6281 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
6282
6283 if (!map->includes_phdrs
6284 && !map->includes_filehdr
6285 && map->p_paddr_valid)
6286 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
6287 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
6288 - segment->p_paddr);
6289
6290 map->count = section_count;
6291 *pointer_to_map = map;
6292 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6293 }
6294
6295 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6296 return TRUE;
6297 }
6298
6299 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
6300 information. */
6301
6302 static bfd_boolean
6303 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6304 {
6305 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6306 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6307 return TRUE;
6308
6309 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
6310 return TRUE;
6311
6312 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6313 {
6314 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
6315 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
6316 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6317 asection *section, *osec;
6318 unsigned int i, num_segments;
6319 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6320 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6321
6322 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6323
6324 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
6325 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
6326 goto rewrite;
6327
6328 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
6329 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6330 section = section->next)
6331 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6332
6333 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6334 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6335 i < num_segments;
6336 i++, segment++)
6337 {
6338 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
6339 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
6340 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
6341 map in this case. */
6342 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
6343 && segment->p_memsz == 0
6344 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
6345 goto rewrite;
6346
6347 for (section = ibfd->sections;
6348 section != NULL; section = section->next)
6349 {
6350 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6351 from the input BFD. */
6352 osec = section->output_section;
6353 if (osec)
6354 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6355
6356 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
6357 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6358 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6359 {
6360 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6361 removed. What else do we need to check? */
6362 if (osec == NULL
6363 || section->flags != osec->flags
6364 || section->lma != osec->lma
6365 || section->vma != osec->vma
6366 || section->size != osec->size
6367 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6368 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6369 goto rewrite;
6370 }
6371 }
6372 }
6373
6374 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6375 input BFD. */
6376 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6377 section = section->next)
6378 {
6379 if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6380 goto rewrite;
6381 else
6382 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6383 }
6384
6385 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6386 }
6387
6388 rewrite:
6389 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6390 {
6391 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
6392 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
6393 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6394 unsigned int i;
6395 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6396 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
6397
6398 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6399 i < num_segments;
6400 i++, segment++)
6401 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6402 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
6403 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
6404
6405 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
6406 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
6407 }
6408
6409 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6410 }
6411
6412 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
6413
6414 bfd_boolean
6415 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6416 asection *isec,
6417 bfd *obfd,
6418 asection *osec,
6419 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6420
6421 {
6422 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6423 bfd_boolean final_link = link_info != NULL && !link_info->relocatable;
6424
6425 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6426 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6427 return TRUE;
6428
6429 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
6430
6431 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
6432 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
6433 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
6434 that the linker clears to differ. */
6435 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6436 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
6437 || (final_link
6438 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
6439 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
6440 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6441
6442 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
6443 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6444 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6445
6446 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
6447 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6448 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
6449 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
6450 if (!final_link)
6451 {
6452 if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
6453 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6454 {
6455 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
6456 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
6457 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6458 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
6459 }
6460 }
6461
6462 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6463
6464 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
6465 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
6466 may be NULL at this point. */
6467 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
6468 {
6469 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6470 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
6471 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
6472 }
6473
6474 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
6475
6476 return TRUE;
6477 }
6478
6479 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
6480 field, and sometimes the info field. */
6481
6482 bfd_boolean
6483 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6484 asection *isec,
6485 bfd *obfd,
6486 asection *osec)
6487 {
6488 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6489
6490 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6491 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6492 return TRUE;
6493
6494 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6495 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6496
6497 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
6498
6499 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
6500 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
6501 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
6502 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
6503 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
6504
6505 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
6506 NULL);
6507 }
6508
6509 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
6510 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
6511 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
6512 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
6513 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
6514 from the linker. */
6515
6516 bfd_boolean
6517 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
6518 {
6519 asection *isec;
6520
6521 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
6522 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
6523 {
6524 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6525 asection *s = first;
6526 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
6527
6528 while (s != NULL)
6529 {
6530 /* If this member section is being output but the
6531 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
6532 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
6533 if (s->output_section != discarded
6534 && isec->output_section == discarded)
6535 {
6536 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
6537 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
6538 }
6539 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
6540 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
6541 else if (s->output_section == discarded
6542 && isec->output_section != discarded)
6543 removed += 4;
6544 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
6545 if (s == first)
6546 break;
6547 }
6548 if (removed != 0)
6549 {
6550 if (discarded != NULL)
6551 {
6552 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
6553 adjust the input section size. This function may
6554 be called multiple times, so save the original
6555 size. */
6556 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6557 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6558 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
6559 }
6560 else
6561 {
6562 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
6563 objcopy. */
6564 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
6565 }
6566 }
6567 }
6568
6569 return TRUE;
6570 }
6571
6572 /* Copy private header information. */
6573
6574 bfd_boolean
6575 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6576 {
6577 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6578 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6579 return TRUE;
6580
6581 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
6582 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
6583 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
6584 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
6585 already been worked out. */
6586 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
6587 {
6588 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
6589 return FALSE;
6590 }
6591
6592 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
6593 }
6594
6595 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
6596 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
6597 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
6598 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
6599 swap_out_syms function. */
6600
6601 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
6602 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
6603 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
6604 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
6605 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
6606
6607 bfd_boolean
6608 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
6609 asymbol *isymarg,
6610 bfd *obfd,
6611 asymbol *osymarg)
6612 {
6613 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
6614
6615 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6616 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6617 return TRUE;
6618
6619 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
6620 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
6621
6622 if (isym != NULL
6623 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
6624 && osym != NULL
6625 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
6626 {
6627 unsigned int shndx;
6628
6629 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6630 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
6631 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
6632 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
6633 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
6634 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
6635 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
6636 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
6637 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
6638 else if (shndx == elf_symtab_shndx (ibfd))
6639 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
6640 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6641 }
6642
6643 return TRUE;
6644 }
6645
6646 /* Swap out the symbols. */
6647
6648 static bfd_boolean
6649 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
6650 struct bfd_strtab_hash **sttp,
6651 int relocatable_p)
6652 {
6653 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6654 int symcount;
6655 asymbol **syms;
6656 struct bfd_strtab_hash *stt;
6657 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6658 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
6659 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
6660 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
6661 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
6662 int idx;
6663 unsigned int num_locals;
6664 bfd_size_type amt;
6665 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
6666
6667 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
6668 return FALSE;
6669
6670 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
6671 stt = _bfd_elf_stringtab_init ();
6672 if (stt == NULL)
6673 return FALSE;
6674
6675 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6676 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
6677 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6678 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
6679 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6680 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
6681 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
6682 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
6683
6684 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
6685 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6686
6687 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
6688 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
6689 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
6690 {
6691 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6692 return FALSE;
6693 }
6694 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
6695
6696 outbound_shndx = NULL;
6697 symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
6698 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
6699 {
6700 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6701 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
6702 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
6703 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
6704 {
6705 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6706 return FALSE;
6707 }
6708
6709 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
6710 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
6711 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
6712 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6713 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6714 }
6715
6716 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
6717 {
6718 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
6719 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6720 sym.st_name = 0;
6721 sym.st_value = 0;
6722 sym.st_size = 0;
6723 sym.st_info = 0;
6724 sym.st_other = 0;
6725 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
6726 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
6727 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6728 outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6729 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6730 outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6731 }
6732
6733 name_local_sections
6734 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
6735 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
6736
6737 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
6738 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
6739 {
6740 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6741 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
6742 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
6743 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
6744 int type;
6745
6746 if (!name_local_sections
6747 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6748 {
6749 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
6750 sym.st_name = 0;
6751 }
6752 else
6753 {
6754 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) _bfd_stringtab_add (stt,
6755 syms[idx]->name,
6756 TRUE, FALSE);
6757 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
6758 {
6759 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6760 return FALSE;
6761 }
6762 }
6763
6764 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
6765
6766 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
6767 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6768 {
6769 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
6770 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
6771 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
6772 sym.st_size = value;
6773 if (type_ptr == NULL
6774 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
6775 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
6776 else
6777 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
6778 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
6779 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
6780 }
6781 else
6782 {
6783 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
6784 unsigned int shndx;
6785
6786 if (sec->output_section)
6787 {
6788 value += sec->output_offset;
6789 sec = sec->output_section;
6790 }
6791
6792 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
6793 if (! relocatable_p)
6794 value += sec->vma;
6795 sym.st_value = value;
6796 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
6797
6798 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
6799 && type_ptr != NULL
6800 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
6801 {
6802 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
6803 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
6804 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
6805 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6806 switch (shndx)
6807 {
6808 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
6809 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
6810 break;
6811 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
6812 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
6813 break;
6814 case MAP_STRTAB:
6815 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
6816 break;
6817 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
6818 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
6819 break;
6820 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
6821 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx (abfd);
6822 break;
6823 default:
6824 shndx = SHN_ABS;
6825 break;
6826 }
6827 }
6828 else
6829 {
6830 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
6831
6832 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
6833 {
6834 asection *sec2;
6835
6836 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
6837 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
6838 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
6839 demand of applications. For example, it
6840 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
6841 section of a symbol to be a section that is
6842 actually in the output file. */
6843 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
6844 if (sec2 == NULL)
6845 {
6846 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6847 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
6848 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
6849 sec->name);
6850 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6851 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6852 return FALSE;
6853 }
6854
6855 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
6856 BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
6857 }
6858 }
6859
6860 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6861 }
6862
6863 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
6864 type = STT_TLS;
6865 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
6866 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
6867 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
6868 type = STT_FUNC;
6869 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
6870 type = STT_OBJECT;
6871 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
6872 type = STT_RELC;
6873 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
6874 type = STT_SRELC;
6875 else
6876 type = STT_NOTYPE;
6877
6878 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
6879 type = STT_TLS;
6880
6881 /* Processor-specific types. */
6882 if (type_ptr != NULL
6883 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6884 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6885 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
6886
6887 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6888 {
6889 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6890 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6891 else
6892 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
6893 }
6894 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6895 {
6896 #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
6897 if (type == STT_OBJECT)
6898 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
6899 else
6900 #endif
6901 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
6902 }
6903 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
6904 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
6905 ? STB_WEAK
6906 : STB_GLOBAL),
6907 type);
6908 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
6909 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
6910 else
6911 {
6912 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
6913
6914 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
6915 bind = STB_LOCAL;
6916 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
6917 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
6918 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
6919 bind = STB_WEAK;
6920 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6921 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
6922
6923 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
6924 }
6925
6926 if (type_ptr != NULL)
6927 {
6928 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
6929 sym.st_target_internal
6930 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
6931 }
6932 else
6933 {
6934 sym.st_other = 0;
6935 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
6936 }
6937
6938 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6939 outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6940 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6941 outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6942 }
6943
6944 *sttp = stt;
6945 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_stringtab_size (stt);
6946 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6947
6948 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6949 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
6950 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6951 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
6952 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
6953 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
6954
6955 return TRUE;
6956 }
6957
6958 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
6959
6960 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
6961 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
6962 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
6963
6964 long
6965 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6966 {
6967 long symcount;
6968 long symtab_size;
6969 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6970
6971 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6972 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6973 if (symcount > 0)
6974 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6975
6976 return symtab_size;
6977 }
6978
6979 long
6980 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6981 {
6982 long symcount;
6983 long symtab_size;
6984 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
6985
6986 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6987 {
6988 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6989 return -1;
6990 }
6991
6992 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6993 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6994 if (symcount > 0)
6995 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6996
6997 return symtab_size;
6998 }
6999
7000 long
7001 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7002 sec_ptr asect)
7003 {
7004 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
7005 }
7006
7007 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
7008
7009 long
7010 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7011 sec_ptr section,
7012 arelent **relptr,
7013 asymbol **symbols)
7014 {
7015 arelent *tblptr;
7016 unsigned int i;
7017 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7018
7019 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
7020 return -1;
7021
7022 tblptr = section->relocation;
7023 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
7024 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
7025
7026 *relptr = NULL;
7027
7028 return section->reloc_count;
7029 }
7030
7031 long
7032 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
7033 {
7034 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7035 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
7036
7037 if (symcount >= 0)
7038 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7039 return symcount;
7040 }
7041
7042 long
7043 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
7044 asymbol **allocation)
7045 {
7046 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7047 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
7048
7049 if (symcount >= 0)
7050 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7051 return symcount;
7052 }
7053
7054 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
7055 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
7056 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
7057 dynamic reloc section. */
7058
7059 long
7060 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7061 {
7062 long ret;
7063 asection *s;
7064
7065 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7066 {
7067 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7068 return -1;
7069 }
7070
7071 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
7072 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7073 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7074 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7075 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7076 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
7077 * sizeof (arelent *));
7078
7079 return ret;
7080 }
7081
7082 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
7083 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
7084 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
7085 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
7086 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
7087 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
7088 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
7089
7090 long
7091 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7092 arelent **storage,
7093 asymbol **syms)
7094 {
7095 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
7096 asection *s;
7097 long ret;
7098
7099 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7100 {
7101 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7102 return -1;
7103 }
7104
7105 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
7106 ret = 0;
7107 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7108 {
7109 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7110 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7111 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7112 {
7113 arelent *p;
7114 long count, i;
7115
7116 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
7117 return -1;
7118 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
7119 p = s->relocation;
7120 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
7121 *storage++ = p++;
7122 ret += count;
7123 }
7124 }
7125
7126 *storage = NULL;
7127
7128 return ret;
7129 }
7130 \f
7131 /* Read in the version information. */
7132
7133 bfd_boolean
7134 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
7135 {
7136 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
7137 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
7138
7139 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
7140 {
7141 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7142 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
7143 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
7144 unsigned int i;
7145 bfd_byte *contents_end;
7146
7147 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
7148
7149 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
7150 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
7151 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
7152 goto error_return;
7153
7154 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = hdr->sh_info;
7155
7156 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7157 if (contents == NULL)
7158 {
7159 error_return_verref:
7160 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
7161 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
7162 goto error_return;
7163 }
7164 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7165 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7166 goto error_return_verref;
7167
7168 if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
7169 goto error_return_verref;
7170
7171 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
7172 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
7173 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
7174 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
7175 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
7176 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
7177 {
7178 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
7179 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
7180 unsigned int j;
7181
7182 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
7183
7184 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
7185
7186 iverneed->vn_filename =
7187 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7188 iverneed->vn_file);
7189 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
7190 goto error_return_verref;
7191
7192 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
7193 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
7194 else
7195 {
7196 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
7197 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
7198 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
7199 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
7200 goto error_return_verref;
7201 }
7202
7203 if (iverneed->vn_aux
7204 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7205 goto error_return_verref;
7206
7207 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7208 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
7209 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
7210 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
7211 {
7212 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
7213
7214 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
7215 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7216 ivernaux->vna_name);
7217 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
7218 goto error_return_verref;
7219
7220 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
7221 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
7222 else
7223 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
7224
7225 if (ivernaux->vna_next
7226 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
7227 goto error_return_verref;
7228
7229 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7230 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
7231
7232 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
7233 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
7234 }
7235
7236 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
7237 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
7238 else
7239 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
7240
7241 if (iverneed->vn_next
7242 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7243 goto error_return_verref;
7244
7245 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
7246 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
7247 }
7248
7249 free (contents);
7250 contents = NULL;
7251 }
7252
7253 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
7254 {
7255 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7256 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
7257 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7258 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
7259 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
7260 unsigned int i;
7261 unsigned int maxidx;
7262 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
7263
7264 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
7265
7266 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7267 if (contents == NULL)
7268 goto error_return;
7269 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7270 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7271 goto error_return;
7272
7273 if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
7274 goto error_return;
7275
7276 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
7277 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
7278 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
7279 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
7280 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
7281 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
7282
7283 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
7284 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
7285 the maximum. */
7286 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7287 maxidx = 0;
7288 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
7289 {
7290 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7291
7292 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
7293 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
7294
7295 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
7296 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7297 goto error_return;
7298
7299 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7300 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
7301 }
7302
7303 if (default_imported_symver)
7304 {
7305 if (freeidx > maxidx)
7306 maxidx = ++freeidx;
7307 else
7308 freeidx = ++maxidx;
7309 }
7310 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7311 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7312 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7313 goto error_return;
7314
7315 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
7316
7317 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7318 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
7319 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
7320 {
7321 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
7322 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7323 unsigned int j;
7324
7325 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7326
7327 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
7328 {
7329 error_return_verdef:
7330 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
7331 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
7332 goto error_return;
7333 }
7334
7335 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
7336 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7337
7338 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7339
7340 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
7341 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
7342 else
7343 {
7344 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7345 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
7346 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7347 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7348 goto error_return_verdef;
7349 }
7350
7351 if (iverdef->vd_aux
7352 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7353 goto error_return_verdef;
7354
7355 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7356 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
7357 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7358 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
7359 {
7360 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
7361
7362 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
7363 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7364 iverdaux->vda_name);
7365 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
7366 goto error_return_verdef;
7367
7368 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
7369 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
7370 else
7371 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7372
7373 if (iverdaux->vda_next
7374 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
7375 goto error_return_verdef;
7376
7377 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7378 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
7379 }
7380
7381 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
7382 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
7383
7384 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
7385 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
7386 else
7387 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7388
7389 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7390 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
7391 }
7392
7393 free (contents);
7394 contents = NULL;
7395 }
7396 else if (default_imported_symver)
7397 {
7398 if (freeidx < 3)
7399 freeidx = 3;
7400 else
7401 freeidx++;
7402
7403 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7404 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7405 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7406 goto error_return;
7407
7408 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
7409 }
7410
7411 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
7412 if (default_imported_symver)
7413 {
7414 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7415 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7416
7417 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
7418
7419 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
7420 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
7421 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
7422 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
7423
7424 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7425
7426 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
7427 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
7428 goto error_return_verdef;
7429 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7430 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7431 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7432 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7433 goto error_return_verdef;
7434
7435 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7436 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
7437 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7438 }
7439
7440 return TRUE;
7441
7442 error_return:
7443 if (contents != NULL)
7444 free (contents);
7445 return FALSE;
7446 }
7447 \f
7448 asymbol *
7449 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
7450 {
7451 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
7452 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (elf_symbol_type);
7453
7454 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7455 if (!newsym)
7456 return NULL;
7457 else
7458 {
7459 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
7460 return &newsym->symbol;
7461 }
7462 }
7463
7464 void
7465 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7466 asymbol *symbol,
7467 symbol_info *ret)
7468 {
7469 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
7470 }
7471
7472 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
7473 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
7474 override it. */
7475
7476 bfd_boolean
7477 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7478 const char *name)
7479 {
7480 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
7481 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
7482 return TRUE;
7483
7484 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
7485 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
7486 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
7487 return TRUE;
7488
7489 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
7490 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
7491 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
7492 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
7493 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
7494 we treat such symbols as local. */
7495 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
7496 return TRUE;
7497
7498 return FALSE;
7499 }
7500
7501 alent *
7502 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7503 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7504 {
7505 abort ();
7506 return NULL;
7507 }
7508
7509 bfd_boolean
7510 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
7511 enum bfd_architecture arch,
7512 unsigned long machine)
7513 {
7514 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
7515 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
7516 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
7517 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
7518 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
7519 return FALSE;
7520
7521 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
7522 }
7523
7524 /* Find the function to a particular section and offset,
7525 for error reporting. */
7526
7527 static bfd_boolean
7528 elf_find_function (bfd *abfd,
7529 asection *section,
7530 asymbol **symbols,
7531 bfd_vma offset,
7532 const char **filename_ptr,
7533 const char **functionname_ptr)
7534 {
7535 struct elf_find_function_cache
7536 {
7537 asection *last_section;
7538 asymbol *func;
7539 const char *filename;
7540 bfd_size_type func_size;
7541 } *cache;
7542
7543 if (symbols == NULL)
7544 return FALSE;
7545
7546 cache = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_find_function_cache;
7547 if (cache == NULL)
7548 {
7549 cache = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*cache));
7550 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_find_function_cache = cache;
7551 if (cache == NULL)
7552 return FALSE;
7553 }
7554 if (cache->last_section != section
7555 || cache->func == NULL
7556 || offset < cache->func->value
7557 || offset >= cache->func->value + cache->func_size)
7558 {
7559 asymbol *file;
7560 bfd_vma low_func;
7561 asymbol **p;
7562 /* ??? Given multiple file symbols, it is impossible to reliably
7563 choose the right file name for global symbols. File symbols are
7564 local symbols, and thus all file symbols must sort before any
7565 global symbols. The ELF spec may be interpreted to say that a
7566 file symbol must sort before other local symbols, but currently
7567 ld -r doesn't do this. So, for ld -r output, it is possible to
7568 make a better choice of file name for local symbols by ignoring
7569 file symbols appearing after a given local symbol. */
7570 enum { nothing_seen, symbol_seen, file_after_symbol_seen } state;
7571 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7572
7573 file = NULL;
7574 low_func = 0;
7575 state = nothing_seen;
7576 cache->filename = NULL;
7577 cache->func = NULL;
7578 cache->func_size = 0;
7579 cache->last_section = section;
7580
7581 for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
7582 {
7583 asymbol *sym = *p;
7584 bfd_vma code_off;
7585 bfd_size_type size;
7586
7587 if ((sym->flags & BSF_FILE) != 0)
7588 {
7589 file = sym;
7590 if (state == symbol_seen)
7591 state = file_after_symbol_seen;
7592 continue;
7593 }
7594
7595 size = bed->maybe_function_sym (sym, section, &code_off);
7596 if (size != 0
7597 && code_off <= offset
7598 && (code_off > low_func
7599 || (code_off == low_func
7600 && size > cache->func_size)))
7601 {
7602 cache->func = sym;
7603 cache->func_size = size;
7604 cache->filename = NULL;
7605 low_func = code_off;
7606 if (file != NULL
7607 && ((sym->flags & BSF_LOCAL) != 0
7608 || state != file_after_symbol_seen))
7609 cache->filename = bfd_asymbol_name (file);
7610 }
7611 if (state == nothing_seen)
7612 state = symbol_seen;
7613 }
7614 }
7615
7616 if (cache->func == NULL)
7617 return FALSE;
7618
7619 if (filename_ptr)
7620 *filename_ptr = cache->filename;
7621 if (functionname_ptr)
7622 *functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (cache->func);
7623
7624 return TRUE;
7625 }
7626
7627 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
7628 for error reporting. */
7629
7630 bfd_boolean
7631 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
7632 asection *section,
7633 asymbol **symbols,
7634 bfd_vma offset,
7635 const char **filename_ptr,
7636 const char **functionname_ptr,
7637 unsigned int *line_ptr)
7638 {
7639 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line_discriminator (abfd, section, symbols,
7640 offset, filename_ptr,
7641 functionname_ptr,
7642 line_ptr,
7643 NULL);
7644 }
7645
7646 bfd_boolean
7647 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line_discriminator (bfd *abfd,
7648 asection *section,
7649 asymbol **symbols,
7650 bfd_vma offset,
7651 const char **filename_ptr,
7652 const char **functionname_ptr,
7653 unsigned int *line_ptr,
7654 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
7655 {
7656 bfd_boolean found;
7657
7658 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7659 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7660 line_ptr))
7661 {
7662 if (!*functionname_ptr)
7663 elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7664 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7665 functionname_ptr);
7666
7667 return TRUE;
7668 }
7669
7670 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, dwarf_debug_sections,
7671 section, symbols, offset,
7672 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7673 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr, 0,
7674 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
7675 {
7676 if (!*functionname_ptr)
7677 elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7678 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7679 functionname_ptr);
7680
7681 return TRUE;
7682 }
7683
7684 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
7685 &found, filename_ptr,
7686 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7687 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
7688 return FALSE;
7689 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
7690 return TRUE;
7691
7692 if (symbols == NULL)
7693 return FALSE;
7694
7695 if (! elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7696 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
7697 return FALSE;
7698
7699 *line_ptr = 0;
7700 return TRUE;
7701 }
7702
7703 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
7704
7705 bfd_boolean
7706 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
7707 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
7708 {
7709 return _bfd_elf_find_line_discriminator (abfd, symbols, symbol,
7710 filename_ptr, line_ptr,
7711 NULL);
7712 }
7713
7714 bfd_boolean
7715 _bfd_elf_find_line_discriminator (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
7716 const char **filename_ptr,
7717 unsigned int *line_ptr,
7718 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
7719 {
7720 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_line (abfd, symbols, symbol,
7721 filename_ptr, line_ptr, discriminator_ptr, 0,
7722 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7723 }
7724
7725 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
7726 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
7727 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
7728 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
7729 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
7730
7731 bfd_boolean
7732 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
7733 const char **filename_ptr,
7734 const char **functionname_ptr,
7735 unsigned int *line_ptr)
7736 {
7737 bfd_boolean found;
7738 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
7739 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7740 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7741 return found;
7742 }
7743
7744 int
7745 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7746 {
7747 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7748 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
7749
7750 if (!info->relocatable)
7751 {
7752 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
7753
7754 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
7755 {
7756 struct elf_segment_map *m;
7757
7758 phdr_size = 0;
7759 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
7760 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
7761
7762 if (phdr_size == 0)
7763 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
7764 }
7765
7766 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
7767 ret += phdr_size;
7768 }
7769
7770 return ret;
7771 }
7772
7773 bfd_boolean
7774 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
7775 sec_ptr section,
7776 const void *location,
7777 file_ptr offset,
7778 bfd_size_type count)
7779 {
7780 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7781 bfd_signed_vma pos;
7782
7783 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
7784 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
7785 return FALSE;
7786
7787 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
7788 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
7789 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
7790 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
7791 return FALSE;
7792
7793 return TRUE;
7794 }
7795
7796 void
7797 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7798 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7799 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7800 {
7801 abort ();
7802 }
7803
7804 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
7805
7806 bfd_boolean
7807 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
7808 {
7809 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
7810
7811 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
7812 {
7813 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
7814 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7815
7816 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
7817 equivalent ELF reloc. */
7818
7819 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
7820 {
7821 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7822 {
7823 case 8:
7824 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
7825 break;
7826 case 12:
7827 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
7828 break;
7829 case 16:
7830 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
7831 break;
7832 case 24:
7833 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
7834 break;
7835 case 32:
7836 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
7837 break;
7838 case 64:
7839 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
7840 break;
7841 default:
7842 goto fail;
7843 }
7844
7845 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7846
7847 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
7848 {
7849 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
7850 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
7851 else
7852 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
7853 }
7854 }
7855 else
7856 {
7857 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7858 {
7859 case 8:
7860 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
7861 break;
7862 case 14:
7863 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
7864 break;
7865 case 16:
7866 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
7867 break;
7868 case 26:
7869 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
7870 break;
7871 case 32:
7872 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
7873 break;
7874 case 64:
7875 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
7876 break;
7877 default:
7878 goto fail;
7879 }
7880
7881 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7882 }
7883
7884 if (howto)
7885 areloc->howto = howto;
7886 else
7887 goto fail;
7888 }
7889
7890 return TRUE;
7891
7892 fail:
7893 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7894 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
7895 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
7896 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7897 return FALSE;
7898 }
7899
7900 bfd_boolean
7901 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
7902 {
7903 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
7904 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
7905 {
7906 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
7907 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
7908 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7909 }
7910
7911 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
7912 }
7913
7914 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
7915 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
7916 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
7917 this reloc. */
7918
7919 bfd_reloc_status_type
7920 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
7921 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7922 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7923 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7924 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7925 {
7926 return bfd_reloc_ok;
7927 }
7928 \f
7929 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
7930 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
7931 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
7932 out details about the corefile. */
7933
7934 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
7935 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
7936 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
7937 # include <sys/procfs.h>
7938 #endif
7939
7940 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
7941 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
7942
7943 static int
7944 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
7945 {
7946 int pid;
7947
7948 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
7949 if (pid == 0)
7950 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
7951
7952 return pid;
7953 }
7954
7955 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
7956 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
7957 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
7958 overwrite it. */
7959
7960 static bfd_boolean
7961 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
7962 {
7963 asection *sect2;
7964
7965 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
7966 return TRUE;
7967
7968 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
7969 if (sect2 == NULL)
7970 return FALSE;
7971
7972 sect2->size = sect->size;
7973 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
7974 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
7975 return TRUE;
7976 }
7977
7978 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
7979 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
7980 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
7981 such a section already exists.
7982 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
7983 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
7984 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
7985 bfd_boolean
7986 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7987 char *name,
7988 size_t size,
7989 ufile_ptr filepos)
7990 {
7991 char buf[100];
7992 char *threaded_name;
7993 size_t len;
7994 asection *sect;
7995
7996 /* Build the section name. */
7997
7998 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7999 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8000 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8001 if (threaded_name == NULL)
8002 return FALSE;
8003 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
8004
8005 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
8006 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8007 if (sect == NULL)
8008 return FALSE;
8009 sect->size = size;
8010 sect->filepos = filepos;
8011 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8012
8013 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
8014 }
8015
8016 /* prstatus_t exists on:
8017 solaris 2.5+
8018 linux 2.[01] + glibc
8019 unixware 4.2
8020 */
8021
8022 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8023
8024 static bfd_boolean
8025 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8026 {
8027 size_t size;
8028 int offset;
8029
8030 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
8031 {
8032 prstatus_t prstat;
8033
8034 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8035 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
8036 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8037
8038 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8039 has already been set by another thread. */
8040 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8041 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8042 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8043 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8044
8045 /* pr_who exists on:
8046 solaris 2.5+
8047 unixware 4.2
8048 pr_who doesn't exist on:
8049 linux 2.[01]
8050 */
8051 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
8052 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8053 #else
8054 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8055 #endif
8056 }
8057 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8058 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
8059 {
8060 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8061 prstatus32_t prstat;
8062
8063 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8064 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
8065 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8066
8067 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8068 has already been set by another thread. */
8069 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8070 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8071 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8072 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8073
8074 /* pr_who exists on:
8075 solaris 2.5+
8076 unixware 4.2
8077 pr_who doesn't exist on:
8078 linux 2.[01]
8079 */
8080 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
8081 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8082 #else
8083 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8084 #endif
8085 }
8086 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
8087 else
8088 {
8089 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8090 note size (ie. data object type). */
8091 return TRUE;
8092 }
8093
8094 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
8095 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
8096 size, note->descpos + offset);
8097 }
8098 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
8099
8100 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
8101 static bfd_boolean
8102 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8103 char *name,
8104 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8105 {
8106 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
8107 note->descsz, note->descpos);
8108 }
8109
8110 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
8111 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
8112 data structure apart. */
8113
8114 static bfd_boolean
8115 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8116 {
8117 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8118 }
8119
8120 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
8121 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
8122 literally. */
8123
8124 static bfd_boolean
8125 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8126 {
8127 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8128 }
8129
8130 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
8131 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
8132 contents literally. */
8133
8134 static bfd_boolean
8135 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8136 {
8137 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
8138 }
8139
8140 static bfd_boolean
8141 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8142 {
8143 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
8144 }
8145
8146 static bfd_boolean
8147 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8148 {
8149 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
8150 }
8151
8152 static bfd_boolean
8153 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8154 {
8155 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
8156 }
8157
8158 static bfd_boolean
8159 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8160 {
8161 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
8162 }
8163
8164 static bfd_boolean
8165 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8166 {
8167 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
8168 }
8169
8170 static bfd_boolean
8171 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8172 {
8173 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
8174 }
8175
8176 static bfd_boolean
8177 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8178 {
8179 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
8180 }
8181
8182 static bfd_boolean
8183 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8184 {
8185 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
8186 }
8187
8188 static bfd_boolean
8189 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8190 {
8191 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
8192 }
8193
8194 static bfd_boolean
8195 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8196 {
8197 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
8198 }
8199
8200 static bfd_boolean
8201 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8202 {
8203 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
8204 }
8205
8206 static bfd_boolean
8207 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8208 {
8209 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
8210 }
8211
8212 static bfd_boolean
8213 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8214 {
8215 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
8216 }
8217
8218 static bfd_boolean
8219 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8220 {
8221 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
8222 }
8223
8224 static bfd_boolean
8225 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8226 {
8227 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
8228 }
8229
8230 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
8231 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8232 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8233 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8234 #endif
8235 #endif
8236
8237 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8238 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8239 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8240 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8241 #endif
8242 #endif
8243
8244 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
8245 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
8246 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
8247
8248 char *
8249 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
8250 {
8251 char *dups;
8252 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
8253 size_t len;
8254
8255 if (end == NULL)
8256 len = max;
8257 else
8258 len = end - start;
8259
8260 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
8261 if (dups == NULL)
8262 return NULL;
8263
8264 memcpy (dups, start, len);
8265 dups[len] = '\0';
8266
8267 return dups;
8268 }
8269
8270 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8271 static bfd_boolean
8272 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8273 {
8274 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
8275 {
8276 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
8277
8278 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8279
8280 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
8281 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8282 #endif
8283 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8284 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8285 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8286
8287 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8288 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8289 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8290 }
8291 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8292 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
8293 {
8294 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8295 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
8296
8297 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8298
8299 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
8300 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8301 #endif
8302 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8303 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8304 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8305
8306 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8307 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8308 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8309 }
8310 #endif
8311
8312 else
8313 {
8314 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8315 note size (ie. data object type). */
8316 return TRUE;
8317 }
8318
8319 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
8320 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
8321 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
8322
8323 {
8324 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
8325 int n = strlen (command);
8326
8327 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
8328 command[n - 1] = '\0';
8329 }
8330
8331 return TRUE;
8332 }
8333 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
8334
8335 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8336 static bfd_boolean
8337 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8338 {
8339 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
8340 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
8341 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
8342 #endif
8343 )
8344 {
8345 pstatus_t pstat;
8346
8347 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8348
8349 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8350 }
8351 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8352 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
8353 {
8354 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8355 pstatus32_t pstat;
8356
8357 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8358
8359 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8360 }
8361 #endif
8362 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
8363 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
8364 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
8365
8366 return TRUE;
8367 }
8368 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
8369
8370 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8371 static bfd_boolean
8372 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8373 {
8374 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8375 char buf[100];
8376 char *name;
8377 size_t len;
8378 asection *sect;
8379
8380 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
8381 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
8382 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
8383 #endif
8384 )
8385 return TRUE;
8386
8387 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
8388
8389 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
8390 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
8391 another thread. */
8392 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8393 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
8394
8395 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8396
8397 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8398 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8399 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8400 if (name == NULL)
8401 return FALSE;
8402 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8403
8404 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8405 if (sect == NULL)
8406 return FALSE;
8407
8408 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8409 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8410 sect->filepos = note->descpos
8411 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8412 #endif
8413
8414 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8415 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
8416 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
8417 #endif
8418
8419 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8420
8421 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8422 return FALSE;
8423
8424 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
8425
8426 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8427 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8428 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8429 if (name == NULL)
8430 return FALSE;
8431 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8432
8433 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8434 if (sect == NULL)
8435 return FALSE;
8436
8437 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8438 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8439 sect->filepos = note->descpos
8440 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8441 #endif
8442
8443 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
8444 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
8445 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
8446 #endif
8447
8448 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8449
8450 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
8451 }
8452 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
8453
8454 static bfd_boolean
8455 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8456 {
8457 char buf[30];
8458 char *name;
8459 size_t len;
8460 asection *sect;
8461 int type;
8462 int is_active_thread;
8463 bfd_vma base_addr;
8464
8465 if (note->descsz < 728)
8466 return TRUE;
8467
8468 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
8469 return TRUE;
8470
8471 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
8472
8473 switch (type)
8474 {
8475 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
8476 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
8477 /* process_info.pid */
8478 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8479 /* process_info.signal */
8480 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
8481 break;
8482
8483 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
8484 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8485 /* thread_info.tid */
8486 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
8487
8488 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8489 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8490 if (name == NULL)
8491 return FALSE;
8492
8493 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8494
8495 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8496 if (sect == NULL)
8497 return FALSE;
8498
8499 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8500 sect->size = 716;
8501 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8502 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
8503 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8504
8505 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
8506 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8507
8508 if (is_active_thread)
8509 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8510 return FALSE;
8511 break;
8512
8513 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
8514 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
8515 /* module_info.base_address */
8516 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
8517 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
8518
8519 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8520 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8521 if (name == NULL)
8522 return FALSE;
8523
8524 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8525
8526 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8527
8528 if (sect == NULL)
8529 return FALSE;
8530
8531 sect->size = note->descsz;
8532 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8533 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8534 break;
8535
8536 default:
8537 return TRUE;
8538 }
8539
8540 return TRUE;
8541 }
8542
8543 static bfd_boolean
8544 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8545 {
8546 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8547
8548 switch (note->type)
8549 {
8550 default:
8551 return TRUE;
8552
8553 case NT_PRSTATUS:
8554 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
8555 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
8556 return TRUE;
8557 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8558 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
8559 #else
8560 return TRUE;
8561 #endif
8562
8563 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8564 case NT_PSTATUS:
8565 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
8566 #endif
8567
8568 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8569 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
8570 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
8571 #endif
8572
8573 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
8574 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
8575
8576 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
8577 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
8578
8579 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
8580 if (note->namesz == 6
8581 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8582 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
8583 else
8584 return TRUE;
8585
8586 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
8587 if (note->namesz == 6
8588 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8589 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
8590 else
8591 return TRUE;
8592
8593 case NT_PPC_VMX:
8594 if (note->namesz == 6
8595 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8596 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
8597 else
8598 return TRUE;
8599
8600 case NT_PPC_VSX:
8601 if (note->namesz == 6
8602 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8603 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
8604 else
8605 return TRUE;
8606
8607 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
8608 if (note->namesz == 6
8609 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8610 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
8611 else
8612 return TRUE;
8613
8614 case NT_S390_TIMER:
8615 if (note->namesz == 6
8616 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8617 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
8618 else
8619 return TRUE;
8620
8621 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
8622 if (note->namesz == 6
8623 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8624 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
8625 else
8626 return TRUE;
8627
8628 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
8629 if (note->namesz == 6
8630 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8631 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
8632 else
8633 return TRUE;
8634
8635 case NT_S390_CTRS:
8636 if (note->namesz == 6
8637 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8638 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
8639 else
8640 return TRUE;
8641
8642 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
8643 if (note->namesz == 6
8644 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8645 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
8646 else
8647 return TRUE;
8648
8649 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
8650 if (note->namesz == 6
8651 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8652 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
8653 else
8654 return TRUE;
8655
8656 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
8657 if (note->namesz == 6
8658 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8659 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
8660 else
8661 return TRUE;
8662
8663 case NT_S390_TDB:
8664 if (note->namesz == 6
8665 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8666 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
8667 else
8668 return TRUE;
8669
8670 case NT_ARM_VFP:
8671 if (note->namesz == 6
8672 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8673 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
8674 else
8675 return TRUE;
8676
8677 case NT_ARM_TLS:
8678 if (note->namesz == 6
8679 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8680 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
8681 else
8682 return TRUE;
8683
8684 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
8685 if (note->namesz == 6
8686 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8687 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
8688 else
8689 return TRUE;
8690
8691 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
8692 if (note->namesz == 6
8693 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
8694 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
8695 else
8696 return TRUE;
8697
8698 case NT_PRPSINFO:
8699 case NT_PSINFO:
8700 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
8701 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
8702 return TRUE;
8703 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8704 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
8705 #else
8706 return TRUE;
8707 #endif
8708
8709 case NT_AUXV:
8710 {
8711 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8712 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8713
8714 if (sect == NULL)
8715 return FALSE;
8716 sect->size = note->descsz;
8717 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8718 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8719
8720 return TRUE;
8721 }
8722
8723 case NT_FILE:
8724 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
8725 note);
8726
8727 case NT_SIGINFO:
8728 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
8729 note);
8730 }
8731 }
8732
8733 static bfd_boolean
8734 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8735 {
8736 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
8737
8738 if (note->descsz == 0)
8739 return FALSE;
8740
8741 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
8742 t->build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*t->build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
8743 if (t->build_id == NULL)
8744 return FALSE;
8745
8746 t->build_id->size = note->descsz;
8747 memcpy (t->build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
8748
8749 return TRUE;
8750 }
8751
8752 static bfd_boolean
8753 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8754 {
8755 switch (note->type)
8756 {
8757 default:
8758 return TRUE;
8759
8760 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
8761 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
8762 }
8763 }
8764
8765 static bfd_boolean
8766 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8767 {
8768 struct sdt_note *cur =
8769 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
8770 + note->descsz);
8771
8772 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
8773 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
8774 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
8775
8776 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
8777
8778 return TRUE;
8779 }
8780
8781 static bfd_boolean
8782 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8783 {
8784 switch (note->type)
8785 {
8786 case NT_STAPSDT:
8787 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
8788
8789 default:
8790 return TRUE;
8791 }
8792 }
8793
8794 static bfd_boolean
8795 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
8796 {
8797 char *cp;
8798
8799 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
8800 if (cp != NULL)
8801 {
8802 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
8803 return TRUE;
8804 }
8805 return FALSE;
8806 }
8807
8808 static bfd_boolean
8809 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8810 {
8811 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8812 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
8813 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8814
8815 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
8816 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
8817 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
8818
8819 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8820 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8821 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
8822
8823 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
8824 note);
8825 }
8826
8827 static bfd_boolean
8828 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8829 {
8830 int lwp;
8831
8832 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
8833 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
8834
8835 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
8836 {
8837 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
8838 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
8839 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
8840 creates a core file. */
8841
8842 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8843 }
8844
8845 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
8846 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
8847 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
8848 understand it. */
8849
8850 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
8851 return TRUE;
8852
8853
8854 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
8855 {
8856 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
8857 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
8858
8859 case bfd_arch_alpha:
8860 case bfd_arch_sparc:
8861 switch (note->type)
8862 {
8863 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
8864 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8865
8866 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
8867 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8868
8869 default:
8870 return TRUE;
8871 }
8872
8873 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
8874 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
8875
8876 default:
8877 switch (note->type)
8878 {
8879 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
8880 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8881
8882 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
8883 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8884
8885 default:
8886 return TRUE;
8887 }
8888 }
8889 /* NOTREACHED */
8890 }
8891
8892 static bfd_boolean
8893 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8894 {
8895 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8896 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
8897 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8898
8899 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
8900 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
8901 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
8902
8903 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8904 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8905 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
8906
8907 return TRUE;
8908 }
8909
8910 static bfd_boolean
8911 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8912 {
8913 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
8914 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8915
8916 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
8917 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8918
8919 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
8920 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8921
8922 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
8923 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8924
8925 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
8926 {
8927 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
8928 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8929
8930 if (sect == NULL)
8931 return FALSE;
8932 sect->size = note->descsz;
8933 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8934 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8935
8936 return TRUE;
8937 }
8938
8939 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
8940 {
8941 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
8942 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8943
8944 if (sect == NULL)
8945 return FALSE;
8946 sect->size = note->descsz;
8947 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8948 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
8949
8950 return TRUE;
8951 }
8952
8953 return TRUE;
8954 }
8955
8956 static bfd_boolean
8957 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
8958 {
8959 void *ddata = note->descdata;
8960 char buf[100];
8961 char *name;
8962 asection *sect;
8963 short sig;
8964 unsigned flags;
8965
8966 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
8967 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
8968
8969 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
8970 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
8971
8972 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
8973 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
8974
8975 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
8976 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
8977 {
8978 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
8979 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
8980 }
8981
8982 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
8983 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
8984 thread just in case. */
8985 if (flags & 0x00000080)
8986 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
8987
8988 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
8989 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
8990
8991 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8992 if (name == NULL)
8993 return FALSE;
8994 strcpy (name, buf);
8995
8996 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8997 if (sect == NULL)
8998 return FALSE;
8999
9000 sect->size = note->descsz;
9001 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9002 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9003
9004 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
9005 }
9006
9007 static bfd_boolean
9008 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
9009 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9010 long tid,
9011 char *base)
9012 {
9013 char buf[100];
9014 char *name;
9015 asection *sect;
9016
9017 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
9018 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
9019
9020 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
9021 if (name == NULL)
9022 return FALSE;
9023 strcpy (name, buf);
9024
9025 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9026 if (sect == NULL)
9027 return FALSE;
9028
9029 sect->size = note->descsz;
9030 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9031 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9032
9033 /* This is the current thread. */
9034 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
9035 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
9036
9037 return TRUE;
9038 }
9039
9040 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
9041 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
9042 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
9043 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
9044
9045 static bfd_boolean
9046 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9047 {
9048 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
9049 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
9050 function. */
9051 static long tid = 1;
9052
9053 switch (note->type)
9054 {
9055 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
9056 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
9057 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
9058 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
9059 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
9060 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
9061 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
9062 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
9063 default:
9064 return TRUE;
9065 }
9066 }
9067
9068 static bfd_boolean
9069 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9070 {
9071 char *name;
9072 asection *sect;
9073 size_t len;
9074
9075 /* Use note name as section name. */
9076 len = note->namesz;
9077 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9078 if (name == NULL)
9079 return FALSE;
9080 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
9081 name[len - 1] = '\0';
9082
9083 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9084 if (sect == NULL)
9085 return FALSE;
9086
9087 sect->size = note->descsz;
9088 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9089 sect->alignment_power = 1;
9090
9091 return TRUE;
9092 }
9093
9094 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
9095
9096 Inputs:
9097 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
9098 name of note
9099 type of note
9100 data for note
9101 size of data for note
9102
9103 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
9104 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
9105 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
9106 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
9107
9108 Return:
9109 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
9110
9111 char *
9112 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
9113 char *buf,
9114 int *bufsiz,
9115 const char *name,
9116 int type,
9117 const void *input,
9118 int size)
9119 {
9120 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
9121 size_t namesz;
9122 size_t newspace;
9123 char *dest;
9124
9125 namesz = 0;
9126 if (name != NULL)
9127 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
9128
9129 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
9130
9131 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
9132 if (buf == NULL)
9133 return buf;
9134 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
9135 *bufsiz += newspace;
9136 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
9137 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
9138 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
9139 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
9140 dest = xnp->name;
9141 if (name != NULL)
9142 {
9143 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
9144 dest += namesz;
9145 while (namesz & 3)
9146 {
9147 *dest++ = '\0';
9148 ++namesz;
9149 }
9150 }
9151 memcpy (dest, input, size);
9152 dest += size;
9153 while (size & 3)
9154 {
9155 *dest++ = '\0';
9156 ++size;
9157 }
9158 return buf;
9159 }
9160
9161 char *
9162 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
9163 char *buf,
9164 int *bufsiz,
9165 const char *fname,
9166 const char *psargs)
9167 {
9168 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9169
9170 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9171 {
9172 char *ret;
9173 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9174 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
9175 if (ret != NULL)
9176 return ret;
9177 }
9178
9179 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9180 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9181 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9182 {
9183 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9184 psinfo32_t data;
9185 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9186 #else
9187 prpsinfo32_t data;
9188 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9189 #endif
9190
9191 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9192 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9193 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9194 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9195 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9196 }
9197 else
9198 #endif
9199 {
9200 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9201 psinfo_t data;
9202 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9203 #else
9204 prpsinfo_t data;
9205 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9206 #endif
9207
9208 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9209 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9210 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9211 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9212 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9213 }
9214 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
9215
9216 free (buf);
9217 return NULL;
9218 }
9219
9220 char *
9221 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
9222 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9223 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9224 {
9225 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32 data;
9226
9227 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9228 LINUX_PRPSINFO32_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9229
9230 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
9231 &data, sizeof (data));
9232 }
9233
9234 char *
9235 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
9236 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9237 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9238 {
9239 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64 data;
9240
9241 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9242 LINUX_PRPSINFO64_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9243
9244 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9245 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
9246 }
9247
9248 char *
9249 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
9250 char *buf,
9251 int *bufsiz,
9252 long pid,
9253 int cursig,
9254 const void *gregs)
9255 {
9256 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9257
9258 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9259 {
9260 char *ret;
9261 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9262 NT_PRSTATUS,
9263 pid, cursig, gregs);
9264 if (ret != NULL)
9265 return ret;
9266 }
9267
9268 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9269 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9270 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9271 {
9272 prstatus32_t prstat;
9273
9274 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9275 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9276 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9277 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9278 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9279 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9280 }
9281 else
9282 #endif
9283 {
9284 prstatus_t prstat;
9285
9286 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9287 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9288 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9289 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9290 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9291 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9292 }
9293 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
9294
9295 free (buf);
9296 return NULL;
9297 }
9298
9299 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9300 char *
9301 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
9302 char *buf,
9303 int *bufsiz,
9304 long pid,
9305 int cursig,
9306 const void *gregs)
9307 {
9308 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9309 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9310
9311 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
9312 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
9313 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9314 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9315 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
9316 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9317 #if !defined(gregs)
9318 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
9319 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
9320 #else
9321 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
9322 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
9323 #endif
9324 #endif
9325 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9326 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
9327 }
9328 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
9329
9330 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9331 char *
9332 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
9333 char *buf,
9334 int *bufsiz,
9335 long pid,
9336 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9337 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9338 {
9339 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9340 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9341 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9342
9343 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9344 {
9345 pstatus32_t pstat;
9346
9347 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9348 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9349 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9350 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9351 return buf;
9352 }
9353 else
9354 #endif
9355 {
9356 pstatus_t pstat;
9357
9358 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9359 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9360 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9361 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9362 return buf;
9363 }
9364 }
9365 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
9366
9367 char *
9368 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9369 char *buf,
9370 int *bufsiz,
9371 const void *fpregs,
9372 int size)
9373 {
9374 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9375 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9376 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
9377 }
9378
9379 char *
9380 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9381 char *buf,
9382 int *bufsiz,
9383 const void *xfpregs,
9384 int size)
9385 {
9386 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9387 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9388 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
9389 }
9390
9391 char *
9392 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9393 const void *xfpregs, int size)
9394 {
9395 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9396 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9397 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
9398 }
9399
9400 char *
9401 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
9402 char *buf,
9403 int *bufsiz,
9404 const void *ppc_vmx,
9405 int size)
9406 {
9407 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9408 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9409 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
9410 }
9411
9412 char *
9413 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
9414 char *buf,
9415 int *bufsiz,
9416 const void *ppc_vsx,
9417 int size)
9418 {
9419 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9420 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9421 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
9422 }
9423
9424 static char *
9425 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
9426 char *buf,
9427 int *bufsiz,
9428 const void *s390_high_gprs,
9429 int size)
9430 {
9431 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9432 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9433 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
9434 s390_high_gprs, size);
9435 }
9436
9437 char *
9438 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
9439 char *buf,
9440 int *bufsiz,
9441 const void *s390_timer,
9442 int size)
9443 {
9444 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9445 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9446 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
9447 }
9448
9449 char *
9450 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
9451 char *buf,
9452 int *bufsiz,
9453 const void *s390_todcmp,
9454 int size)
9455 {
9456 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9457 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9458 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
9459 }
9460
9461 char *
9462 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
9463 char *buf,
9464 int *bufsiz,
9465 const void *s390_todpreg,
9466 int size)
9467 {
9468 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9469 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9470 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
9471 }
9472
9473 char *
9474 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
9475 char *buf,
9476 int *bufsiz,
9477 const void *s390_ctrs,
9478 int size)
9479 {
9480 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9481 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9482 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
9483 }
9484
9485 char *
9486 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
9487 char *buf,
9488 int *bufsiz,
9489 const void *s390_prefix,
9490 int size)
9491 {
9492 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9493 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9494 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
9495 }
9496
9497 char *
9498 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
9499 char *buf,
9500 int *bufsiz,
9501 const void *s390_last_break,
9502 int size)
9503 {
9504 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9505 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9506 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
9507 s390_last_break, size);
9508 }
9509
9510 char *
9511 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
9512 char *buf,
9513 int *bufsiz,
9514 const void *s390_system_call,
9515 int size)
9516 {
9517 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9518 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9519 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
9520 s390_system_call, size);
9521 }
9522
9523 char *
9524 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
9525 char *buf,
9526 int *bufsiz,
9527 const void *s390_tdb,
9528 int size)
9529 {
9530 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9531 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9532 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
9533 }
9534
9535 char *
9536 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
9537 char *buf,
9538 int *bufsiz,
9539 const void *arm_vfp,
9540 int size)
9541 {
9542 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9543 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9544 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
9545 }
9546
9547 char *
9548 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
9549 char *buf,
9550 int *bufsiz,
9551 const void *aarch_tls,
9552 int size)
9553 {
9554 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9555 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9556 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
9557 }
9558
9559 char *
9560 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
9561 char *buf,
9562 int *bufsiz,
9563 const void *aarch_hw_break,
9564 int size)
9565 {
9566 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9567 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9568 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
9569 }
9570
9571 char *
9572 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
9573 char *buf,
9574 int *bufsiz,
9575 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
9576 int size)
9577 {
9578 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9579 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9580 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
9581 }
9582
9583 char *
9584 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
9585 char *buf,
9586 int *bufsiz,
9587 const char *section,
9588 const void *data,
9589 int size)
9590 {
9591 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
9592 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9593 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
9594 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9595 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
9596 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9597 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
9598 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9599 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
9600 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9601 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
9602 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9603 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
9604 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9605 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
9606 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9607 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
9608 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9609 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
9610 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9611 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
9612 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9613 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
9614 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9615 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
9616 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9617 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
9618 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9619 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
9620 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9621 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
9622 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9623 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
9624 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9625 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
9626 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
9627 return NULL;
9628 }
9629
9630 static bfd_boolean
9631 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
9632 {
9633 char *p;
9634
9635 p = buf;
9636 while (p < buf + size)
9637 {
9638 /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
9639 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
9640 Elf_Internal_Note in;
9641
9642 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
9643 return FALSE;
9644
9645 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
9646
9647 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
9648 in.namedata = xnp->name;
9649 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
9650 return FALSE;
9651
9652 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
9653 in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
9654 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
9655 if (in.descsz != 0
9656 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
9657 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
9658 return FALSE;
9659
9660 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
9661 {
9662 default:
9663 return TRUE;
9664
9665 case bfd_core:
9666 if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "NetBSD-CORE"))
9667 {
9668 if (! elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9669 return FALSE;
9670 }
9671 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "OpenBSD"))
9672 {
9673 if (! elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (abfd, &in))
9674 return FALSE;
9675 }
9676 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "QNX"))
9677 {
9678 if (! elfcore_grok_nto_note (abfd, &in))
9679 return FALSE;
9680 }
9681 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "SPU/"))
9682 {
9683 if (! elfcore_grok_spu_note (abfd, &in))
9684 return FALSE;
9685 }
9686 else
9687 {
9688 if (! elfcore_grok_note (abfd, &in))
9689 return FALSE;
9690 }
9691 break;
9692
9693 case bfd_object:
9694 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
9695 {
9696 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
9697 return FALSE;
9698 }
9699 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
9700 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
9701 {
9702 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
9703 return FALSE;
9704 }
9705 break;
9706 }
9707
9708 p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
9709 }
9710
9711 return TRUE;
9712 }
9713
9714 static bfd_boolean
9715 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
9716 {
9717 char *buf;
9718
9719 if (size <= 0)
9720 return TRUE;
9721
9722 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
9723 return FALSE;
9724
9725 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size);
9726 if (buf == NULL)
9727 return FALSE;
9728
9729 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
9730 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
9731 {
9732 free (buf);
9733 return FALSE;
9734 }
9735
9736 free (buf);
9737 return TRUE;
9738 }
9739 \f
9740 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
9741
9742 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
9743 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
9744 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
9745
9746 long
9747 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
9748 {
9749 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9750 {
9751 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9752 return -1;
9753 }
9754
9755 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
9756 }
9757
9758 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
9759 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
9760 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
9761 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
9762
9763 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
9764 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
9765
9766 int
9767 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
9768 {
9769 int num_phdrs;
9770
9771 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9772 {
9773 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
9774 return -1;
9775 }
9776
9777 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
9778 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
9779 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
9780
9781 return num_phdrs;
9782 }
9783
9784 enum elf_reloc_type_class
9785 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9786 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9787 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9788 {
9789 return reloc_class_normal;
9790 }
9791
9792 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
9793 relocation against a local symbol. */
9794
9795 bfd_vma
9796 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9797 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9798 asection **psec,
9799 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9800 {
9801 asection *sec = *psec;
9802 bfd_vma relocation;
9803
9804 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
9805 + sec->output_offset
9806 + sym->st_value);
9807 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
9808 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
9809 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9810 {
9811 rel->r_addend =
9812 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9813 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9814 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
9815 if (sec != *psec)
9816 {
9817 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
9818 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
9819 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
9820 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
9821 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
9822 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
9823 sec->kept_section = *psec;
9824 sec = *psec;
9825 }
9826 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
9827 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9828 }
9829 return relocation;
9830 }
9831
9832 bfd_vma
9833 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
9834 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
9835 asection **psec,
9836 bfd_vma addend)
9837 {
9838 asection *sec = *psec;
9839
9840 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
9841 return sym->st_value + addend;
9842
9843 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
9844 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9845 sym->st_value + addend);
9846 }
9847
9848 bfd_vma
9849 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
9850 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9851 asection *sec,
9852 bfd_vma offset)
9853 {
9854 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
9855 {
9856 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
9857 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
9858 offset);
9859 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
9860 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
9861 default:
9862 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
9863 {
9864 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9865 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
9866 offset = sec->size - offset - address_size;
9867 }
9868 return offset;
9869 }
9870 }
9871 \f
9872 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
9873 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
9874 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
9875 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
9876 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
9877 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
9878
9879 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
9880 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
9881 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
9882 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
9883 the remote memory. */
9884
9885 bfd *
9886 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
9887 (bfd *templ,
9888 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
9889 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
9890 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
9891 {
9892 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
9893 (templ, ehdr_vma, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
9894 }
9895 \f
9896 long
9897 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
9898 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9899 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9900 long dynsymcount,
9901 asymbol **dynsyms,
9902 asymbol **ret)
9903 {
9904 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9905 asection *relplt;
9906 asymbol *s;
9907 const char *relplt_name;
9908 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
9909 arelent *p;
9910 long count, i, n;
9911 size_t size;
9912 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9913 char *names;
9914 asection *plt;
9915
9916 *ret = NULL;
9917
9918 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
9919 return 0;
9920
9921 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
9922 return 0;
9923
9924 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
9925 return 0;
9926
9927 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
9928 if (relplt_name == NULL)
9929 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
9930 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
9931 if (relplt == NULL)
9932 return 0;
9933
9934 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
9935 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
9936 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
9937 return 0;
9938
9939 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
9940 if (plt == NULL)
9941 return 0;
9942
9943 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
9944 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
9945 return -1;
9946
9947 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
9948 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
9949 p = relplt->relocation;
9950 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9951 {
9952 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
9953 if (p->addend != 0)
9954 {
9955 #ifdef BFD64
9956 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
9957 #else
9958 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
9959 #endif
9960 }
9961 }
9962
9963 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
9964 if (s == NULL)
9965 return -1;
9966
9967 names = (char *) (s + count);
9968 p = relplt->relocation;
9969 n = 0;
9970 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
9971 {
9972 size_t len;
9973 bfd_vma addr;
9974
9975 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
9976 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
9977 continue;
9978
9979 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
9980 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
9981 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
9982 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
9983 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
9984 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
9985 s->section = plt;
9986 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
9987 s->name = names;
9988 s->udata.p = NULL;
9989 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
9990 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
9991 names += len;
9992 if (p->addend != 0)
9993 {
9994 char buf[30], *a;
9995
9996 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
9997 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
9998 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
9999 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
10000 ;
10001 len = strlen (a);
10002 memcpy (names, a, len);
10003 names += len;
10004 }
10005 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
10006 names += sizeof ("@plt");
10007 ++s, ++n;
10008 }
10009
10010 return n;
10011 }
10012
10013 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far. */
10014 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
10015 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
10016 SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
10017
10018 void
10019 _bfd_elf_set_osabi (bfd * abfd,
10020 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10021 {
10022 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
10023
10024 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
10025
10026 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
10027
10028 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
10029 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
10030 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
10031 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
10032 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
10033 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
10034 }
10035
10036
10037 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
10038 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
10039 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
10040
10041 bfd_boolean
10042 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
10043 {
10044 return (type == STT_FUNC
10045 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
10046 }
10047
10048 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
10049 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
10050 otherwise return zero. */
10051
10052 bfd_size_type
10053 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
10054 bfd_vma *code_off)
10055 {
10056 bfd_size_type size;
10057
10058 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
10059 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
10060 || sym->section != sec)
10061 return 0;
10062
10063 *code_off = sym->value;
10064 size = 0;
10065 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
10066 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
10067 if (size == 0)
10068 size = 1;
10069 return size;
10070 }